1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 14 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 15 #include <linux/list.h> 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/netlink.h> 18 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 19 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 20 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 21 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 22 #include <linux/net.h> 23 #include <net/regulatory.h> 24 25 /** 26 * DOC: Introduction 27 * 28 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 29 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 30 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 31 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 32 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 33 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 34 * 35 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 36 * use restrictions. 37 */ 38 39 40 /** 41 * DOC: Device registration 42 * 43 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 44 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 45 * described below. 46 * 47 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 48 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 49 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 50 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 51 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 52 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 53 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 54 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 55 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 56 * 57 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 58 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 59 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 60 */ 61 62 struct wiphy; 63 64 /* 65 * wireless hardware capability structures 66 */ 67 68 /** 69 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 70 * 71 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 72 * 73 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 74 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 75 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 78 * is not permitted. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 80 * is not permitted. 81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 83 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 84 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 85 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 86 * restrictions. 87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 88 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 91 * restrictions. 92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 93 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 94 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 95 * on this channel. 96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 97 * on this channel. 98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 102 * on this channel. 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 104 * on this channel. 105 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 106 * on this channel. 107 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 108 * on this channel. 109 * 110 */ 111 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 112 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 113 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 114 /* hole at 1<<2 */ 115 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 116 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 117 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 118 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 119 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 120 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 121 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 131 }; 132 133 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 134 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 135 136 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 137 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 138 139 /** 140 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 141 * 142 * This structure describes a single channel for use 143 * with cfg80211. 144 * 145 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 146 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 147 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 148 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 149 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 150 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 151 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 152 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 153 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 154 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 155 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 156 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 157 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 158 * @orig_mag: internal use 159 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 160 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 161 * on this channel. 162 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 163 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 164 */ 165 struct ieee80211_channel { 166 enum nl80211_band band; 167 u32 center_freq; 168 u16 freq_offset; 169 u16 hw_value; 170 u32 flags; 171 int max_antenna_gain; 172 int max_power; 173 int max_reg_power; 174 bool beacon_found; 175 u32 orig_flags; 176 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 177 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 178 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 179 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 180 }; 181 182 /** 183 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 184 * 185 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 186 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 187 * different bands/PHY modes. 188 * 189 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 190 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 191 * with CCK rates. 192 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 193 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 194 * core code when registering the wiphy. 195 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 196 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 197 * core code when registering the wiphy. 198 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 199 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 200 * core code when registering the wiphy. 201 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 202 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 203 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 204 */ 205 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 206 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 207 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 208 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 209 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 210 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 211 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 212 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 213 }; 214 215 /** 216 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 217 * 218 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 219 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 220 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 221 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 222 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 223 */ 224 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 225 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 226 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 227 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 228 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 229 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 230 }; 231 232 /** 233 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 234 * 235 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 236 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 237 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 238 */ 239 enum ieee80211_privacy { 240 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 241 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 242 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 243 }; 244 245 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 246 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 247 248 /** 249 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 250 * 251 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 252 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 253 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 254 * passed around. 255 * 256 * @flags: rate-specific flags 257 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 258 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 259 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 260 * short preamble is used 261 */ 262 struct ieee80211_rate { 263 u32 flags; 264 u16 bitrate; 265 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 266 }; 267 268 /** 269 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 270 * 271 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 272 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 273 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 274 */ 275 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 276 bool enable; 277 u8 min_offset; 278 u8 max_offset; 279 }; 280 281 /** 282 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 283 * 284 * @color: the current color. 285 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 286 * @partial: define the AID equation. 287 */ 288 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 289 u8 color; 290 bool enabled; 291 bool partial; 292 }; 293 294 /** 295 * struct ieee80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 296 * 297 * @color: the current color. 298 * @disabled: is the feature disabled. 299 * @partial: define the AID equation. 300 */ 301 struct ieee80211_he_bss_color { 302 u8 color; 303 bool disabled; 304 bool partial; 305 }; 306 307 /** 308 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 309 * 310 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 311 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 312 * 313 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 314 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 315 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 316 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 317 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 318 */ 319 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 320 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 321 bool ht_supported; 322 u8 ampdu_factor; 323 u8 ampdu_density; 324 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 325 }; 326 327 /** 328 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 329 * 330 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 331 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 332 * 333 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 334 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 335 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 336 */ 337 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 338 bool vht_supported; 339 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 340 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 341 }; 342 343 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 344 345 /** 346 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 347 * 348 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 349 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 350 * 351 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 352 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 353 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 354 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 355 */ 356 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 357 bool has_he; 358 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 359 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 360 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 361 }; 362 363 /** 364 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data 365 * 366 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 367 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 368 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 369 * 370 * @types_mask: interface types mask 371 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 372 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 373 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 374 */ 375 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 376 u16 types_mask; 377 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 378 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 379 }; 380 381 /** 382 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 383 * 384 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 385 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 386 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 387 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 388 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 389 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 390 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 391 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 392 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 393 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 394 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 395 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 396 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 397 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 398 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 399 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 400 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 401 */ 402 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 403 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 404 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 405 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 406 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 407 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 408 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 409 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 410 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 411 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 412 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 413 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 414 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 415 }; 416 417 /** 418 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 419 * 420 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 421 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 422 * 423 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 424 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 425 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 426 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 427 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 428 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 429 */ 430 struct ieee80211_edmg { 431 u8 channels; 432 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 433 }; 434 435 /** 436 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 437 * 438 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 439 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 440 * 441 * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA 442 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 443 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 444 */ 445 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 446 bool s1g; 447 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 448 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 449 }; 450 451 /** 452 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 453 * 454 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 455 * is able to operate in. 456 * 457 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 458 * in this band. 459 * @band: the band this structure represents 460 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 461 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 462 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 463 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 464 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 465 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 466 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 467 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 468 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 469 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 470 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 471 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 472 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 473 * iftype_data). 474 */ 475 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 476 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 477 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 478 enum nl80211_band band; 479 int n_channels; 480 int n_bitrates; 481 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 482 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 483 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 484 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 485 u16 n_iftype_data; 486 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data; 487 }; 488 489 /** 490 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 491 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 492 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 493 * 494 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 495 */ 496 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 497 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 498 u8 iftype) 499 { 500 int i; 501 502 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 503 return NULL; 504 505 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) { 506 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 507 &sband->iftype_data[i]; 508 509 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 510 return data; 511 } 512 513 return NULL; 514 } 515 516 /** 517 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 518 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 519 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 520 * 521 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 522 */ 523 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 524 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 525 u8 iftype) 526 { 527 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 528 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 529 530 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 531 return &data->he_cap; 532 533 return NULL; 534 } 535 536 /** 537 * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA 538 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 539 * 540 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 541 */ 542 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 543 ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband) 544 { 545 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION); 546 } 547 548 /** 549 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 550 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 551 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 552 * 553 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 554 */ 555 static inline __le16 556 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 557 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 558 { 559 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 560 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 561 562 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 563 return 0; 564 565 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 566 } 567 568 /** 569 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 570 * 571 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 572 * 573 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 574 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 575 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 576 * 577 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 578 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 579 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 580 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 581 * without affecting other devices. 582 * 583 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 584 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 585 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 586 */ 587 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 588 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 589 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 590 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 591 { 592 } 593 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 594 595 596 /* 597 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 598 */ 599 600 /** 601 * DOC: Actions and configuration 602 * 603 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 604 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 605 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 606 * operations use are described separately. 607 * 608 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 609 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 610 * 611 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 612 * in a separate chapter. 613 */ 614 615 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 616 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 617 618 /** 619 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 620 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 621 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 622 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 623 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 624 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 625 * determine the address as needed. 626 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 627 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 628 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 629 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 630 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 631 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 632 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 633 */ 634 struct vif_params { 635 u32 flags; 636 int use_4addr; 637 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 638 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 639 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 640 }; 641 642 /** 643 * struct key_params - key information 644 * 645 * Information about a key 646 * 647 * @key: key material 648 * @key_len: length of key material 649 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 650 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 651 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 652 * length given by @seq_len. 653 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 654 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 655 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 656 */ 657 struct key_params { 658 const u8 *key; 659 const u8 *seq; 660 int key_len; 661 int seq_len; 662 u16 vlan_id; 663 u32 cipher; 664 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 665 }; 666 667 /** 668 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 669 * @chan: the (control) channel 670 * @width: channel width 671 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 672 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 673 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 674 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 675 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 676 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 677 * parameters are ignored. 678 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 679 */ 680 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 681 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 682 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 683 u32 center_freq1; 684 u32 center_freq2; 685 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 686 u16 freq1_offset; 687 }; 688 689 /* 690 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 691 */ 692 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 693 struct { 694 u32 legacy; 695 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 696 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 697 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 698 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 699 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 700 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 701 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 702 }; 703 704 705 /** 706 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 707 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 708 * of the peer. 709 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 710 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 711 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 712 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 713 * @retry_long: retry count value 714 * @retry_short: retry count value 715 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 716 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 717 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 718 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 719 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 720 */ 721 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 722 bool config_override; 723 u8 tids; 724 u64 mask; 725 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 726 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 727 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 728 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 729 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 730 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 731 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 732 }; 733 734 /** 735 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 736 * @peer: Station's MAC address 737 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 738 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 739 */ 740 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 741 const u8 *peer; 742 u32 n_tid_conf; 743 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[]; 744 }; 745 746 /** 747 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 748 * @chandef: the channel definition 749 * 750 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 751 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 752 */ 753 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 754 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 755 { 756 switch (chandef->width) { 757 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 758 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 759 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 760 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 761 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 762 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 763 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 764 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 765 default: 766 WARN_ON(1); 767 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 768 } 769 } 770 771 /** 772 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 773 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 774 * @channel: the control channel 775 * @chantype: the channel type 776 * 777 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 778 */ 779 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 780 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 781 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 782 783 /** 784 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 785 * @chandef1: first channel definition 786 * @chandef2: second channel definition 787 * 788 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 789 * identical, %false otherwise. 790 */ 791 static inline bool 792 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 793 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 794 { 795 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 796 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 797 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 798 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 799 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 800 } 801 802 /** 803 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 804 * 805 * @chandef: the channel definition 806 * 807 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 808 */ 809 static inline bool 810 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 811 { 812 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 813 } 814 815 /** 816 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 817 * @chandef1: first channel definition 818 * @chandef2: second channel definition 819 * 820 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 821 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 822 */ 823 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 824 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 825 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 826 827 /** 828 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 829 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 830 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 831 */ 832 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 833 834 /** 835 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 836 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 837 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 838 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 839 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 840 */ 841 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 842 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 843 u32 prohibited_flags); 844 845 /** 846 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 847 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 848 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 849 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 850 * Returns: 851 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 852 */ 853 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 854 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 855 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 856 857 /** 858 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 859 * 860 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 861 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 862 * 863 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 864 * 865 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 866 */ 867 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 868 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 869 { 870 switch (chandef->width) { 871 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 872 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 873 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 874 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 875 default: 876 break; 877 } 878 return 0; 879 } 880 881 /** 882 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 883 * 884 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 885 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 886 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 887 * 888 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 889 * 890 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 891 */ 892 static inline int 893 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 894 { 895 switch (chandef->width) { 896 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 897 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 898 chandef->chan->max_power); 899 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 900 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 901 chandef->chan->max_power); 902 default: 903 break; 904 } 905 return chandef->chan->max_power; 906 } 907 908 /** 909 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 910 * 911 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 912 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 913 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 914 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 915 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 916 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 917 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 918 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 919 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 920 * 921 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 922 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 923 */ 924 enum survey_info_flags { 925 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 926 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 927 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 928 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 929 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 930 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 931 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 932 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 933 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 934 }; 935 936 /** 937 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 938 * 939 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 940 * record to report global statistics 941 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 942 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 943 * optional 944 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 945 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 946 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 947 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 948 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 949 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 950 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 951 * 952 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 953 * 954 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 955 * channel duty cycle etc. 956 */ 957 struct survey_info { 958 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 959 u64 time; 960 u64 time_busy; 961 u64 time_ext_busy; 962 u64 time_rx; 963 u64 time_tx; 964 u64 time_scan; 965 u64 time_bss_rx; 966 u32 filled; 967 s8 noise; 968 }; 969 970 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4 971 972 /** 973 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 974 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 975 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 976 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 977 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 978 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 979 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 980 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 981 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 982 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 983 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 984 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 985 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 986 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 987 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 988 * protocol frames. 989 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 990 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 991 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 992 * port for mac80211 993 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 994 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 995 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 996 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 997 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 998 * offload) 999 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1000 */ 1001 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1002 u32 wpa_versions; 1003 u32 cipher_group; 1004 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1005 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1006 int n_akm_suites; 1007 u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES]; 1008 bool control_port; 1009 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1010 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1011 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1012 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1013 struct key_params *wep_keys; 1014 int wep_tx_key; 1015 const u8 *psk; 1016 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1017 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1018 }; 1019 1020 /** 1021 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1022 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1023 * or %NULL if not changed 1024 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1025 * or %NULL if not changed 1026 * @head_len: length of @head 1027 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1028 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1029 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1030 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1031 * frames or %NULL 1032 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1033 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1034 * Response frames or %NULL 1035 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1036 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1037 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1038 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1039 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1040 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1041 * (measurement type 8) 1042 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1043 * Token (measurement type 11) 1044 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1045 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1046 */ 1047 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1048 const u8 *head, *tail; 1049 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1050 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1051 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1052 const u8 *probe_resp; 1053 const u8 *lci; 1054 const u8 *civicloc; 1055 s8 ftm_responder; 1056 1057 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1058 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1059 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1060 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1061 size_t probe_resp_len; 1062 size_t lci_len; 1063 size_t civicloc_len; 1064 }; 1065 1066 struct mac_address { 1067 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1068 }; 1069 1070 /** 1071 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1072 * 1073 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1074 * entry specified by mac_addr 1075 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1076 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1077 */ 1078 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1079 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1080 int n_acl_entries; 1081 1082 /* Keep it last */ 1083 struct mac_address mac_addrs[]; 1084 }; 1085 1086 /** 1087 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1088 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1089 * 1090 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1091 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1092 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1093 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1094 * frame headers. 1095 */ 1096 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1097 u32 min_interval; 1098 u32 max_interval; 1099 size_t tmpl_len; 1100 const u8 *tmpl; 1101 }; 1102 1103 /** 1104 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1105 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1106 * 1107 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1108 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1109 * scanning 1110 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1111 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1112 */ 1113 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1114 u32 interval; 1115 size_t tmpl_len; 1116 const u8 *tmpl; 1117 }; 1118 1119 /** 1120 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 1121 * 1122 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings 1123 * 1124 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication 1125 */ 1126 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags { 1127 AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0), 1128 }; 1129 1130 /** 1131 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1132 * 1133 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1134 * 1135 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1136 * @beacon: beacon data 1137 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1138 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1139 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1140 * user space) 1141 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1142 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1143 * @crypto: crypto settings 1144 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1145 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1146 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1147 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1148 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1149 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1150 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1151 * MAC address based access control 1152 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1153 * networks. 1154 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1155 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1156 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1157 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1158 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1159 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1160 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1161 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1162 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags 1163 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1164 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1165 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1166 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1167 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1168 */ 1169 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1170 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1171 1172 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1173 1174 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1175 const u8 *ssid; 1176 size_t ssid_len; 1177 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1178 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1179 bool privacy; 1180 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1181 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1182 int inactivity_timeout; 1183 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1184 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1185 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1186 bool pbss; 1187 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1188 1189 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1190 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1191 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1192 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1193 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required; 1194 bool twt_responder; 1195 u32 flags; 1196 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1197 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1198 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1199 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1200 }; 1201 1202 /** 1203 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1204 * 1205 * Used for channel switch 1206 * 1207 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1208 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1209 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1210 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1211 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1212 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1213 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1214 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1215 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1216 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1217 */ 1218 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1219 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1220 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1221 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1222 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1223 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1224 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1225 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1226 bool radar_required; 1227 bool block_tx; 1228 u8 count; 1229 }; 1230 1231 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10 1232 1233 /** 1234 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1235 * 1236 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1237 * 1238 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1239 * to use for verification 1240 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1241 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1242 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1243 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1244 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1245 * nl80211_iftype. 1246 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1247 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1248 * the verification 1249 */ 1250 struct iface_combination_params { 1251 int num_different_channels; 1252 u8 radar_detect; 1253 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1254 u32 new_beacon_int; 1255 }; 1256 1257 /** 1258 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1259 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1260 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1261 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1262 * 1263 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1264 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1265 */ 1266 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1267 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1268 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1269 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1270 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3), 1271 }; 1272 1273 /** 1274 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1275 * 1276 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1277 * 1278 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1279 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1280 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1281 * power per-interface or per-station. 1282 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1283 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1284 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1285 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1286 * per peer TPC. 1287 */ 1288 struct sta_txpwr { 1289 s16 power; 1290 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1291 }; 1292 1293 /** 1294 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1295 * 1296 * Used to change and create a new station. 1297 * 1298 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1299 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1300 * (or NULL for no change) 1301 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1302 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1303 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1304 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1305 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1306 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1307 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1308 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1309 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1310 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1311 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1312 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1313 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1314 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1315 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1316 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1317 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1318 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1319 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1320 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1321 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1322 * to unknown) 1323 * @capability: station capability 1324 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1325 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1326 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1327 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1328 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1329 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1330 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1331 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1332 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1333 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1334 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1335 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1336 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1337 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1338 */ 1339 struct station_parameters { 1340 const u8 *supported_rates; 1341 struct net_device *vlan; 1342 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1343 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1344 int listen_interval; 1345 u16 aid; 1346 u16 vlan_id; 1347 u16 peer_aid; 1348 u8 supported_rates_len; 1349 u8 plink_action; 1350 u8 plink_state; 1351 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1352 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1353 u8 uapsd_queues; 1354 u8 max_sp; 1355 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1356 u16 capability; 1357 const u8 *ext_capab; 1358 u8 ext_capab_len; 1359 const u8 *supported_channels; 1360 u8 supported_channels_len; 1361 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1362 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1363 u8 opmode_notif; 1364 bool opmode_notif_used; 1365 int support_p2p_ps; 1366 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1367 u8 he_capa_len; 1368 u16 airtime_weight; 1369 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1370 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1371 }; 1372 1373 /** 1374 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1375 * 1376 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1377 * 1378 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1379 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1380 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1381 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1382 */ 1383 struct station_del_parameters { 1384 const u8 *mac; 1385 u8 subtype; 1386 u16 reason_code; 1387 }; 1388 1389 /** 1390 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1391 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1392 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1393 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1394 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1395 * the AP MLME in the device 1396 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1397 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1398 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1399 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1400 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1401 * supported/used) 1402 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1403 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1404 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1405 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1406 */ 1407 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1408 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1409 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1410 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1411 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1412 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1413 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1414 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1415 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1416 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1417 }; 1418 1419 /** 1420 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1421 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1422 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1423 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1424 * 1425 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1426 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1427 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1428 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1429 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1430 */ 1431 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1432 struct station_parameters *params, 1433 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1434 1435 /** 1436 * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags 1437 * 1438 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1439 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1440 * 1441 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1442 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1443 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1444 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1445 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1446 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1447 */ 1448 enum rate_info_flags { 1449 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1450 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1451 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1452 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1453 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1454 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1455 }; 1456 1457 /** 1458 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1459 * 1460 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1461 * 1462 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1463 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1464 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1465 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1466 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1467 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1468 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1469 */ 1470 enum rate_info_bw { 1471 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1472 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1473 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1474 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1475 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1476 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1477 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1478 }; 1479 1480 /** 1481 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1482 * 1483 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1484 * 1485 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1486 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate 1487 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1488 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1489 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1490 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1491 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1492 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1493 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1494 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1495 */ 1496 struct rate_info { 1497 u8 flags; 1498 u8 mcs; 1499 u16 legacy; 1500 u8 nss; 1501 u8 bw; 1502 u8 he_gi; 1503 u8 he_dcm; 1504 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1505 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1506 }; 1507 1508 /** 1509 * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags 1510 * 1511 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1512 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1513 * 1514 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1515 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1516 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1517 */ 1518 enum bss_param_flags { 1519 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1520 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1521 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1522 }; 1523 1524 /** 1525 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1526 * 1527 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1528 * 1529 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1530 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1531 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1532 */ 1533 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1534 u8 flags; 1535 u8 dtim_period; 1536 u16 beacon_interval; 1537 }; 1538 1539 /** 1540 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1541 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1542 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1543 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1544 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1545 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1546 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1547 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1548 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1549 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1550 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1551 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1552 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1553 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1554 */ 1555 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1556 u32 filled; 1557 u32 backlog_bytes; 1558 u32 backlog_packets; 1559 u32 flows; 1560 u32 drops; 1561 u32 ecn_marks; 1562 u32 overlimit; 1563 u32 overmemory; 1564 u32 collisions; 1565 u32 tx_bytes; 1566 u32 tx_packets; 1567 u32 max_flows; 1568 }; 1569 1570 /** 1571 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1572 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1573 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1574 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1575 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1576 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1577 * transmitted MSDUs 1578 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1579 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1580 */ 1581 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1582 u32 filled; 1583 u64 rx_msdu; 1584 u64 tx_msdu; 1585 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1586 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1587 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1588 }; 1589 1590 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1591 1592 /** 1593 * struct station_info - station information 1594 * 1595 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1596 * 1597 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1598 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1599 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1600 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1601 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1602 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1603 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1604 * @llid: mesh local link id 1605 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1606 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1607 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1608 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1609 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1610 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1611 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1612 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1613 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1614 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1615 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1616 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1617 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1618 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1619 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 1620 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 1621 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 1622 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1623 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 1624 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1625 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1626 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 1627 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 1628 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 1629 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 1630 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 1631 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 1632 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 1633 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 1634 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 1635 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 1636 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 1637 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 1638 * towards this station. 1639 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 1640 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 1641 * from this peer 1642 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 1643 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 1644 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 1645 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 1646 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 1647 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 1648 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 1649 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 1650 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 1651 * been sent. 1652 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 1653 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 1654 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 1655 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 1656 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 1657 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 1658 */ 1659 struct station_info { 1660 u64 filled; 1661 u32 connected_time; 1662 u32 inactive_time; 1663 u64 assoc_at; 1664 u64 rx_bytes; 1665 u64 tx_bytes; 1666 u16 llid; 1667 u16 plid; 1668 u8 plink_state; 1669 s8 signal; 1670 s8 signal_avg; 1671 1672 u8 chains; 1673 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1674 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1675 1676 struct rate_info txrate; 1677 struct rate_info rxrate; 1678 u32 rx_packets; 1679 u32 tx_packets; 1680 u32 tx_retries; 1681 u32 tx_failed; 1682 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 1683 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 1684 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 1685 1686 int generation; 1687 1688 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 1689 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 1690 1691 u32 beacon_loss_count; 1692 s64 t_offset; 1693 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1694 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 1695 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 1696 1697 u32 expected_throughput; 1698 1699 u64 tx_duration; 1700 u64 rx_duration; 1701 u64 rx_beacon; 1702 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 1703 u8 connected_to_gate; 1704 1705 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 1706 s8 ack_signal; 1707 s8 avg_ack_signal; 1708 1709 u16 airtime_weight; 1710 1711 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 1712 u32 fcs_err_count; 1713 1714 u32 airtime_link_metric; 1715 1716 u8 connected_to_as; 1717 }; 1718 1719 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 1720 /** 1721 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 1722 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 1723 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 1724 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 1725 * 1726 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 1727 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 1728 * considered undefined. 1729 */ 1730 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 1731 struct station_info *sinfo); 1732 #else 1733 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 1734 const u8 *mac_addr, 1735 struct station_info *sinfo) 1736 { 1737 return -ENOENT; 1738 } 1739 #endif 1740 1741 /** 1742 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 1743 * 1744 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 1745 * according to the nl80211 flags. 1746 * 1747 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 1748 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 1749 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 1750 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 1751 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 1752 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 1753 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 1754 */ 1755 enum monitor_flags { 1756 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 1757 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 1758 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 1759 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 1760 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 1761 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 1762 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 1763 }; 1764 1765 /** 1766 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 1767 * 1768 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 1769 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 1770 * 1771 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 1772 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 1773 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 1774 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 1775 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 1776 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 1777 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 1778 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 1779 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 1780 */ 1781 enum mpath_info_flags { 1782 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 1783 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 1784 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 1785 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 1786 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 1787 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 1788 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 1789 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 1790 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 1791 }; 1792 1793 /** 1794 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 1795 * 1796 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 1797 * 1798 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 1799 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 1800 * @sn: target sequence number 1801 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 1802 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 1803 * @flags: mesh path flags 1804 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 1805 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 1806 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1807 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 1808 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1809 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1810 * @hop_count: hops to destination 1811 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 1812 */ 1813 struct mpath_info { 1814 u32 filled; 1815 u32 frame_qlen; 1816 u32 sn; 1817 u32 metric; 1818 u32 exptime; 1819 u32 discovery_timeout; 1820 u8 discovery_retries; 1821 u8 flags; 1822 u8 hop_count; 1823 u32 path_change_count; 1824 1825 int generation; 1826 }; 1827 1828 /** 1829 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 1830 * 1831 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 1832 * 1833 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 1834 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1835 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 1836 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1837 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 1838 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1839 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1840 * (or NULL for no change) 1841 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 1842 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 1843 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1844 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 1845 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 1846 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 1847 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 1848 */ 1849 struct bss_parameters { 1850 int use_cts_prot; 1851 int use_short_preamble; 1852 int use_short_slot_time; 1853 const u8 *basic_rates; 1854 u8 basic_rates_len; 1855 int ap_isolate; 1856 int ht_opmode; 1857 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 1858 }; 1859 1860 /** 1861 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 1862 * 1863 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 1864 * 1865 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 1866 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 1867 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 1868 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 1869 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 1870 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 1871 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 1872 * mesh interface 1873 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 1874 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 1875 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 1876 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 1877 * elements 1878 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 1879 * detect compatible mesh peers 1880 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 1881 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 1882 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 1883 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 1884 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 1885 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 1886 * a path discovery in milliseconds 1887 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1888 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 1889 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 1890 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1891 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 1892 * element 1893 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1894 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 1895 * element 1896 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 1897 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 1898 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 1899 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 1900 * announcements are transmitted 1901 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 1902 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 1903 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 1904 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 1905 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 1906 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 1907 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 1908 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 1909 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 1910 * station to establish a peer link 1911 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 1912 * 1913 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1914 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 1915 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 1916 * 1917 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 1918 * PREQs are transmitted. 1919 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 1920 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 1921 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 1922 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 1923 * setting for new peer links. 1924 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 1925 * after transmitting its beacon. 1926 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 1927 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 1928 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 1929 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 1930 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 1931 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 1932 * in the mesh path table 1933 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 1934 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 1935 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 1936 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 1937 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 1938 */ 1939 struct mesh_config { 1940 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 1941 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 1942 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 1943 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 1944 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 1945 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 1946 u8 element_ttl; 1947 bool auto_open_plinks; 1948 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 1949 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 1950 u32 path_refresh_time; 1951 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 1952 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 1953 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 1954 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 1955 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 1956 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 1957 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 1958 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 1959 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 1960 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 1961 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 1962 s32 rssi_threshold; 1963 u16 ht_opmode; 1964 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 1965 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 1966 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 1967 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 1968 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 1969 u32 plink_timeout; 1970 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 1971 }; 1972 1973 /** 1974 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 1975 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1976 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 1977 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 1978 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 1979 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 1980 * @path_metric: which metric to use 1981 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 1982 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 1983 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 1984 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 1985 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 1986 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 1987 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 1988 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 1989 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 1990 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 1991 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1992 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 1993 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 1994 * to operate on DFS channels. 1995 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 1996 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 1997 * 1998 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 1999 */ 2000 struct mesh_setup { 2001 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2002 const u8 *mesh_id; 2003 u8 mesh_id_len; 2004 u8 sync_method; 2005 u8 path_sel_proto; 2006 u8 path_metric; 2007 u8 auth_id; 2008 const u8 *ie; 2009 u8 ie_len; 2010 bool is_authenticated; 2011 bool is_secure; 2012 bool user_mpm; 2013 u8 dtim_period; 2014 u16 beacon_interval; 2015 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2016 u32 basic_rates; 2017 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2018 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2019 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2020 }; 2021 2022 /** 2023 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2024 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2025 * 2026 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2027 */ 2028 struct ocb_setup { 2029 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2030 }; 2031 2032 /** 2033 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2034 * @ac: AC identifier 2035 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2036 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2037 * 1..32767] 2038 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2039 * 1..32767] 2040 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2041 */ 2042 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2043 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2044 u16 txop; 2045 u16 cwmin; 2046 u16 cwmax; 2047 u8 aifs; 2048 }; 2049 2050 /** 2051 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2052 * 2053 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2054 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2055 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2056 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2057 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2058 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2059 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2060 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2061 * in the wiphy structure. 2062 * 2063 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2064 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2065 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2066 * 2067 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2068 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2069 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2070 * to userspace. 2071 */ 2072 2073 /** 2074 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2075 * @ssid: the SSID 2076 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2077 */ 2078 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2079 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2080 u8 ssid_len; 2081 }; 2082 2083 /** 2084 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2085 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2086 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2087 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2088 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2089 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2090 * userspace will be notified of that 2091 */ 2092 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2093 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2094 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2095 bool aborted; 2096 }; 2097 2098 /** 2099 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2100 * 2101 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2102 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2103 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2104 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2105 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2106 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2107 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2108 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2109 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2110 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2111 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2112 * %duration field. 2113 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2114 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2115 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2116 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2117 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2118 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2119 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2120 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2121 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2122 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2123 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2124 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2125 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2126 */ 2127 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2128 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2129 int n_ssids; 2130 u32 n_channels; 2131 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2132 const u8 *ie; 2133 size_t ie_len; 2134 u16 duration; 2135 bool duration_mandatory; 2136 u32 flags; 2137 2138 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2139 2140 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2141 2142 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2143 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2144 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2145 2146 /* internal */ 2147 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2148 unsigned long scan_start; 2149 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2150 bool notified; 2151 bool no_cck; 2152 2153 /* keep last */ 2154 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2155 }; 2156 2157 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2158 { 2159 int i; 2160 2161 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2162 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2163 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2164 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2165 } 2166 } 2167 2168 /** 2169 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2170 * 2171 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2172 * or no match (RSSI only) 2173 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2174 * or no match (RSSI only) 2175 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2176 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2177 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support 2178 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2179 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2180 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2181 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2182 * corresponding matchset. 2183 */ 2184 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2185 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2186 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2187 s32 rssi_thold; 2188 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2189 }; 2190 2191 /** 2192 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2193 * 2194 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2195 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2196 * infinite loop. 2197 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2198 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2199 */ 2200 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2201 u32 interval; 2202 u32 iterations; 2203 }; 2204 2205 /** 2206 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2207 * 2208 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2209 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2210 */ 2211 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2212 enum nl80211_band band; 2213 s8 delta; 2214 }; 2215 2216 /** 2217 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2218 * 2219 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2220 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2221 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2222 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2223 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2224 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2225 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2226 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2227 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2228 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2229 * (others are filtered out). 2230 * If ommited, all results are passed. 2231 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2232 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2233 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2234 * @dev: the interface 2235 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2236 * @channels: channels to scan 2237 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2238 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2239 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2240 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2241 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2242 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2243 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2244 * index must be executed first. 2245 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2246 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2247 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2248 * owned by a particular socket) 2249 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2250 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2251 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2252 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2253 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2254 * supported. 2255 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2256 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2257 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2258 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2259 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2260 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2261 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2262 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2263 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2264 * comparisions. 2265 */ 2266 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2267 u64 reqid; 2268 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2269 int n_ssids; 2270 u32 n_channels; 2271 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2272 const u8 *ie; 2273 size_t ie_len; 2274 u32 flags; 2275 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2276 int n_match_sets; 2277 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2278 u32 delay; 2279 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2280 int n_scan_plans; 2281 2282 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2283 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2284 2285 bool relative_rssi_set; 2286 s8 relative_rssi; 2287 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2288 2289 /* internal */ 2290 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2291 struct net_device *dev; 2292 unsigned long scan_start; 2293 bool report_results; 2294 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2295 u32 owner_nlportid; 2296 bool nl_owner_dead; 2297 struct list_head list; 2298 2299 /* keep last */ 2300 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2301 }; 2302 2303 /** 2304 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2305 * 2306 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2307 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2308 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2309 */ 2310 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2311 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2312 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2313 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2314 }; 2315 2316 /** 2317 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2318 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2319 * @scan_width: scan width that was used 2320 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2321 * signal type 2322 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2323 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2324 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2325 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2326 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2327 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2328 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2329 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2330 * by %parent_bssid. 2331 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2332 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2333 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2334 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2335 */ 2336 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2337 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2338 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2339 s32 signal; 2340 u64 boottime_ns; 2341 u64 parent_tsf; 2342 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2343 u8 chains; 2344 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2345 }; 2346 2347 /** 2348 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2349 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2350 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2351 * @len: length of the IEs 2352 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2353 * @data: IE data 2354 */ 2355 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2356 u64 tsf; 2357 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2358 int len; 2359 bool from_beacon; 2360 u8 data[]; 2361 }; 2362 2363 /** 2364 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2365 * 2366 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2367 * for use in scan results and similar. 2368 * 2369 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2370 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 2371 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2372 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2373 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2374 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2375 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2376 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2377 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2378 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2379 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2380 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2381 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2382 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2383 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2384 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2385 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2386 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2387 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2388 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2389 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2390 * (multi-BSSID support) 2391 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2392 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2393 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2394 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2395 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2396 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2397 */ 2398 struct cfg80211_bss { 2399 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2400 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2401 2402 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2403 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2404 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2405 2406 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2407 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2408 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2409 2410 s32 signal; 2411 2412 u16 beacon_interval; 2413 u16 capability; 2414 2415 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2416 u8 chains; 2417 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2418 2419 u8 bssid_index; 2420 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2421 2422 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2423 }; 2424 2425 /** 2426 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2427 * @bss: the bss to search 2428 * @id: the element ID 2429 * 2430 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2431 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2432 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2433 */ 2434 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2435 2436 /** 2437 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2438 * @bss: the bss to search 2439 * @id: the element ID 2440 * 2441 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2442 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2443 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2444 */ 2445 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2446 { 2447 return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2448 } 2449 2450 2451 /** 2452 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2453 * 2454 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2455 * authentication. 2456 * 2457 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2458 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2459 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2460 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2461 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2462 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2463 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2464 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2465 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2466 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2467 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2468 * transaction sequence number field. 2469 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2470 */ 2471 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2472 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2473 const u8 *ie; 2474 size_t ie_len; 2475 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2476 const u8 *key; 2477 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2478 const u8 *auth_data; 2479 size_t auth_data_len; 2480 }; 2481 2482 /** 2483 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2484 * 2485 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 2486 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 2487 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 2488 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 2489 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 2490 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 2491 * request (connect callback). 2492 */ 2493 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 2494 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 2495 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 2496 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 2497 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 2498 }; 2499 2500 /** 2501 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 2502 * 2503 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2504 * (re)association. 2505 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 2506 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 2507 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 2508 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 2509 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 2510 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2511 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 2512 * @crypto: crypto settings 2513 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2514 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2515 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2516 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2517 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2518 * frame. 2519 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2520 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2521 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2522 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2523 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 2524 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 2525 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 2526 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 2527 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 2528 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 2529 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 2530 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2531 */ 2532 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 2533 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2534 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 2535 size_t ie_len; 2536 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2537 bool use_mfp; 2538 u32 flags; 2539 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2540 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2541 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 2542 const u8 *fils_kek; 2543 size_t fils_kek_len; 2544 const u8 *fils_nonces; 2545 }; 2546 2547 /** 2548 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 2549 * 2550 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2551 * deauthentication. 2552 * 2553 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from 2554 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 2555 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2556 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 2557 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 2558 * do not set a deauth frame 2559 */ 2560 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 2561 const u8 *bssid; 2562 const u8 *ie; 2563 size_t ie_len; 2564 u16 reason_code; 2565 bool local_state_change; 2566 }; 2567 2568 /** 2569 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 2570 * 2571 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2572 * disassociation. 2573 * 2574 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from 2575 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 2576 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2577 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 2578 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 2579 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 2580 */ 2581 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 2582 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2583 const u8 *ie; 2584 size_t ie_len; 2585 u16 reason_code; 2586 bool local_state_change; 2587 }; 2588 2589 /** 2590 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 2591 * 2592 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 2593 * method. 2594 * 2595 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 2596 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 2597 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 2598 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 2599 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 2600 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 2601 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 2602 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 2603 * @ie_len: length of that 2604 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2605 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 2606 * after joining 2607 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 2608 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 2609 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 2610 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 2611 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2612 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2613 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2614 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2615 * to operate on DFS channels. 2616 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 2617 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 2618 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2619 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2620 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2621 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 2622 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 2623 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 2624 */ 2625 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 2626 const u8 *ssid; 2627 const u8 *bssid; 2628 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2629 const u8 *ie; 2630 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 2631 u16 beacon_interval; 2632 u32 basic_rates; 2633 bool channel_fixed; 2634 bool privacy; 2635 bool control_port; 2636 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2637 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2638 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2639 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2640 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2641 struct key_params *wep_keys; 2642 int wep_tx_key; 2643 }; 2644 2645 /** 2646 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 2647 * 2648 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 2649 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 2650 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 2651 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 2652 */ 2653 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 2654 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 2655 union { 2656 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 2657 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 2658 } param; 2659 }; 2660 2661 /** 2662 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 2663 * 2664 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2665 * authentication and association. 2666 * 2667 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 2668 * on scan results) 2669 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 2670 * %NULL if not specified 2671 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 2672 * results) 2673 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 2674 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 2675 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 2676 * to use. 2677 * @ssid: SSID 2678 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 2679 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2680 * @ie: IEs for association request 2681 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 2682 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 2683 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 2684 * @crypto: crypto settings 2685 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2686 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2687 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2688 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2689 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 2690 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 2691 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2692 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2693 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2694 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 2695 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 2696 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 2697 * networks. 2698 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 2699 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2700 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2701 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2702 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2703 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2704 * frame. 2705 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 2706 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 2707 * data IE. 2708 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 2709 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 2710 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 2711 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2712 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 2713 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 2714 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2715 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 2716 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 2717 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 2718 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 2719 * offload of 4-way handshake. 2720 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 2721 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 2722 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 2723 */ 2724 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 2725 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2726 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 2727 const u8 *bssid; 2728 const u8 *bssid_hint; 2729 const u8 *ssid; 2730 size_t ssid_len; 2731 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2732 const u8 *ie; 2733 size_t ie_len; 2734 bool privacy; 2735 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 2736 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2737 const u8 *key; 2738 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2739 u32 flags; 2740 int bg_scan_period; 2741 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2742 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2743 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 2744 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 2745 bool pbss; 2746 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 2747 const u8 *prev_bssid; 2748 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 2749 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 2750 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 2751 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 2752 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 2753 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 2754 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 2755 bool want_1x; 2756 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 2757 }; 2758 2759 /** 2760 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 2761 * 2762 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 2763 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 2764 * 2765 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 2766 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 2767 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 2768 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 2769 */ 2770 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 2771 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 2772 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 2773 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 2774 }; 2775 2776 /** 2777 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 2778 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 2779 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 2780 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 2781 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 2782 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 2783 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 2784 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 2785 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 2786 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 2787 */ 2788 enum wiphy_params_flags { 2789 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 2790 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 2791 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 2792 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 2793 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 2794 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 2795 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 2796 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 2797 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 2798 }; 2799 2800 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 2801 2802 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 2803 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 2804 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 2805 2806 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 2807 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 2808 2809 /** 2810 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 2811 * 2812 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 2813 * caching. 2814 * 2815 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 2816 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 2817 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 2818 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 2819 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 2820 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 2821 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 2822 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 2823 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 2824 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 2825 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 2826 * %NULL). 2827 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 2828 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 2829 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 2830 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 2831 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 2832 * used for it expires. 2833 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 2834 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 2835 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 2836 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 2837 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 2838 */ 2839 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 2840 const u8 *bssid; 2841 const u8 *pmkid; 2842 const u8 *pmk; 2843 size_t pmk_len; 2844 const u8 *ssid; 2845 size_t ssid_len; 2846 const u8 *cache_id; 2847 u32 pmk_lifetime; 2848 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 2849 }; 2850 2851 /** 2852 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 2853 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 2854 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 2855 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 2856 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 2857 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 2858 * 2859 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 2860 * memory, free @mask only! 2861 */ 2862 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 2863 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 2864 int pattern_len; 2865 int pkt_offset; 2866 }; 2867 2868 /** 2869 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 2870 * 2871 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 2872 * @src: source IP address 2873 * @dst: destination IP address 2874 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 2875 * @src_port: source port 2876 * @dst_port: destination port 2877 * @payload_len: data payload length 2878 * @payload: data payload buffer 2879 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 2880 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 2881 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 2882 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 2883 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 2884 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 2885 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 2886 */ 2887 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 2888 struct socket *sock; 2889 __be32 src, dst; 2890 u16 src_port, dst_port; 2891 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 2892 int payload_len; 2893 const u8 *payload; 2894 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 2895 u32 data_interval; 2896 u32 wake_len; 2897 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 2898 u32 tokens_size; 2899 /* must be last, variable member */ 2900 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 2901 }; 2902 2903 /** 2904 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 2905 * 2906 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 2907 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 2908 * operating as normal during suspend 2909 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 2910 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 2911 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 2912 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 2913 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 2914 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 2915 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 2916 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 2917 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 2918 * NULL if not configured. 2919 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 2920 */ 2921 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 2922 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 2923 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 2924 rfkill_release; 2925 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 2926 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 2927 int n_patterns; 2928 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 2929 }; 2930 2931 /** 2932 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 2933 * 2934 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 2935 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 2936 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 2937 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 2938 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 2939 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 2940 */ 2941 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 2942 int delay; 2943 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 2944 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 2945 int n_patterns; 2946 }; 2947 2948 /** 2949 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 2950 * 2951 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 2952 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 2953 * @n_rules: number of rules 2954 */ 2955 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 2956 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 2957 int n_rules; 2958 }; 2959 2960 /** 2961 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 2962 * 2963 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 2964 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 2965 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 2966 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 2967 * occurred (in MHz) 2968 */ 2969 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 2970 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2971 int n_channels; 2972 u32 channels[]; 2973 }; 2974 2975 /** 2976 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 2977 * 2978 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 2979 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 2980 * match information. 2981 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 2982 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 2983 */ 2984 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 2985 int n_matches; 2986 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 2987 }; 2988 2989 /** 2990 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 2991 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 2992 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 2993 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 2994 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 2995 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 2996 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 2997 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 2998 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 2999 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3000 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3001 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3002 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3003 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3004 * it is. 3005 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3006 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3007 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3008 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3009 */ 3010 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3011 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3012 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3013 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3014 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3015 s32 pattern_idx; 3016 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3017 const void *packet; 3018 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3019 }; 3020 3021 /** 3022 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3023 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3024 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3025 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3026 * @kek_len: length of kek 3027 * @kck_len length of kck 3028 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3029 */ 3030 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3031 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3032 u32 akm; 3033 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3034 }; 3035 3036 /** 3037 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3038 * 3039 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3040 * 3041 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3042 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3043 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3044 */ 3045 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3046 u16 md; 3047 const u8 *ie; 3048 size_t ie_len; 3049 }; 3050 3051 /** 3052 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3053 * 3054 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3055 * 3056 * @chan: channel to use 3057 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required 3058 * @wait: duration for ROC 3059 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3060 * @len: buffer length 3061 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3062 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3063 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3064 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3065 */ 3066 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3067 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3068 bool offchan; 3069 unsigned int wait; 3070 const u8 *buf; 3071 size_t len; 3072 bool no_cck; 3073 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3074 int n_csa_offsets; 3075 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3076 }; 3077 3078 /** 3079 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3080 * 3081 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3082 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3083 */ 3084 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3085 u8 dscp; 3086 u8 up; 3087 }; 3088 3089 /** 3090 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3091 * 3092 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3093 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3094 */ 3095 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3096 u8 low; 3097 u8 high; 3098 }; 3099 3100 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3101 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3102 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3103 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3104 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3105 3106 /** 3107 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3108 * 3109 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3110 * 3111 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3112 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3113 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3114 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3115 */ 3116 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3117 u8 num_des; 3118 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3119 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3120 }; 3121 3122 /** 3123 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3124 * 3125 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3126 * 3127 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3128 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3129 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3130 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3131 */ 3132 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3133 u8 master_pref; 3134 u8 bands; 3135 }; 3136 3137 /** 3138 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3139 * configuration 3140 * 3141 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3142 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3143 */ 3144 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3145 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3146 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3147 }; 3148 3149 /** 3150 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3151 * 3152 * @filter: the content of the filter 3153 * @len: the length of the filter 3154 */ 3155 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3156 const u8 *filter; 3157 u8 len; 3158 }; 3159 3160 /** 3161 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3162 * 3163 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3164 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3165 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3166 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3167 * implementation specific. 3168 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3169 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3170 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3171 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up 3172 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3173 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3174 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3175 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3176 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3177 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3178 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3179 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3180 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3181 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3182 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3183 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3184 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3185 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3186 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3187 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3188 */ 3189 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3190 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3191 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3192 u8 publish_type; 3193 bool close_range; 3194 bool publish_bcast; 3195 bool subscribe_active; 3196 u8 followup_id; 3197 u8 followup_reqid; 3198 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3199 u32 ttl; 3200 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3201 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3202 bool srf_include; 3203 const u8 *srf_bf; 3204 u8 srf_bf_len; 3205 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3206 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3207 int srf_num_macs; 3208 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3209 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3210 u8 num_tx_filters; 3211 u8 num_rx_filters; 3212 u8 instance_id; 3213 u64 cookie; 3214 }; 3215 3216 /** 3217 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3218 * 3219 * @aa: authenticator address 3220 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3221 * @pmk: the PMK material 3222 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3223 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3224 * holds PMK-R0. 3225 */ 3226 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3227 const u8 *aa; 3228 u8 pmk_len; 3229 const u8 *pmk; 3230 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3231 }; 3232 3233 /** 3234 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3235 * 3236 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3237 * 3238 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3239 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3240 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3241 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3242 * authentication response command interface. 3243 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3244 * authentication response command interface. 3245 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3246 * authentication request event interface. 3247 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3248 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3249 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3250 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3251 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3252 */ 3253 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3254 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3255 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3256 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3257 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3258 u16 status; 3259 const u8 *pmkid; 3260 }; 3261 3262 /** 3263 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3264 * 3265 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3266 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3267 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3268 * answered 3269 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3270 * successfully answered 3271 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3272 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3273 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3274 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3275 * of how much time the responder was busy 3276 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3277 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3278 * the responder 3279 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3280 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3281 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3282 */ 3283 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3284 u32 filled; 3285 u32 success_num; 3286 u32 partial_num; 3287 u32 failed_num; 3288 u32 asap_num; 3289 u32 non_asap_num; 3290 u64 total_duration_ms; 3291 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3292 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3293 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3294 }; 3295 3296 /** 3297 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3298 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3299 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3300 * reason than just "failure" 3301 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3302 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3303 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3304 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3305 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3306 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3307 * by the responder 3308 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3309 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3310 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3311 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3312 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3313 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3314 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3315 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3316 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3317 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3318 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3319 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3320 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3321 * the square root of the variance) 3322 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3323 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3324 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3325 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3326 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3327 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3328 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3329 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3330 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3331 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3332 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3333 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3334 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3335 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3336 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3337 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3338 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3339 */ 3340 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3341 const u8 *lci; 3342 const u8 *civicloc; 3343 unsigned int lci_len; 3344 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3345 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3346 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3347 s16 burst_index; 3348 u8 busy_retry_time; 3349 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3350 u8 burst_duration; 3351 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3352 s32 rssi_avg; 3353 s32 rssi_spread; 3354 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3355 s64 rtt_avg; 3356 s64 rtt_variance; 3357 s64 rtt_spread; 3358 s64 dist_avg; 3359 s64 dist_variance; 3360 s64 dist_spread; 3361 3362 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3363 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3364 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3365 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3366 tx_rate_valid:1, 3367 rx_rate_valid:1, 3368 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3369 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3370 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3371 dist_avg_valid:1, 3372 dist_variance_valid:1, 3373 dist_spread_valid:1; 3374 }; 3375 3376 /** 3377 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3378 * @addr: address of the peer 3379 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3380 * measurement was made) 3381 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3382 * @status: status of the measurement 3383 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3384 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3385 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3386 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3387 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3388 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3389 */ 3390 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3391 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3392 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3393 3394 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3395 3396 u8 final:1, 3397 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3398 3399 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3400 3401 union { 3402 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3403 }; 3404 }; 3405 3406 /** 3407 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3408 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3409 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3410 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3411 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3412 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3413 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3414 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3415 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3416 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3417 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3418 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3419 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3420 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3421 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3422 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3423 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3424 * 3425 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3426 */ 3427 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3428 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3429 u16 burst_period; 3430 u8 requested:1, 3431 asap:1, 3432 request_lci:1, 3433 request_civicloc:1, 3434 trigger_based:1, 3435 non_trigger_based:1; 3436 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3437 u8 burst_duration; 3438 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3439 u8 ftmr_retries; 3440 }; 3441 3442 /** 3443 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 3444 * @addr: MAC address 3445 * @chandef: channel to use 3446 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 3447 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 3448 */ 3449 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 3450 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3451 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3452 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 3453 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 3454 }; 3455 3456 /** 3457 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 3458 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 3459 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 3460 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 3461 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 3462 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 3463 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 3464 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 3465 * be taken from the @mac_addr 3466 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 3467 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 3468 * zero it means there's no timeout 3469 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 3470 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 3471 */ 3472 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 3473 u64 cookie; 3474 void *drv_data; 3475 u32 n_peers; 3476 u32 nl_portid; 3477 3478 u32 timeout; 3479 3480 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3481 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3482 3483 struct list_head list; 3484 3485 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[]; 3486 }; 3487 3488 /** 3489 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 3490 * 3491 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 3492 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 3493 * 3494 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 3495 * 3496 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 3497 * has to be done. 3498 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 3499 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 3500 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 3501 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 3502 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 3503 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 3504 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 3505 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 3506 */ 3507 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 3508 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3509 u16 status; 3510 const u8 *ie; 3511 size_t ie_len; 3512 }; 3513 3514 /** 3515 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 3516 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3517 * for the entire device 3518 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3519 * for the given interface 3520 * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 3521 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 3522 * for these subtypes 3523 */ 3524 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 3525 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 3526 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 3527 }; 3528 3529 /** 3530 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 3531 * 3532 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 3533 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 3534 * 3535 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 3536 * on success or a negative error code. 3537 * 3538 * All operations are currently invoked under rtnl for consistency with the 3539 * wireless extensions but this is subject to reevaluation as soon as this 3540 * code is used more widely and we have a first user without wext. 3541 * 3542 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 3543 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 3544 * configured for the device. 3545 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 3546 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 3547 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 3548 * the device. 3549 * 3550 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 3551 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 3552 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 3553 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 3554 * also set the address member in the wdev. 3555 * 3556 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 3557 * 3558 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 3559 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 3560 * 3561 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 3562 * when adding a group key. 3563 * 3564 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 3565 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 3566 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 3567 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 3568 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 3569 * 3570 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 3571 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. 3572 * 3573 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface 3574 * 3575 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface 3576 * 3577 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface 3578 * 3579 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 3580 * 3581 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 3582 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 3583 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 3584 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 3585 * 3586 * @add_station: Add a new station. 3587 * @del_station: Remove a station 3588 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 3589 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 3590 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 3591 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 3592 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 3593 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 3594 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3595 * 3596 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 3597 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 3598 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 3599 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 3600 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3601 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 3602 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3603 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 3604 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3605 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 3606 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3607 * 3608 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 3609 * 3610 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 3611 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 3612 * set, and which to leave alone. 3613 * 3614 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 3615 * 3616 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 3617 * 3618 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 3619 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 3620 * join the mesh instead. 3621 * 3622 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 3623 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 3624 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 3625 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 3626 * 3627 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 3628 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 3629 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 3630 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 3631 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 3632 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 3633 * 3634 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 3635 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3636 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 3637 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3638 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 3639 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3640 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 3641 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3642 * 3643 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 3644 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 3645 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 3646 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 3647 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 3648 * was received. 3649 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 3650 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 3651 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 3652 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 3653 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 3654 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 3655 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 3656 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 3657 * indication of requesting reassociation. 3658 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 3659 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 3660 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3661 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 3662 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 3663 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 3664 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 3665 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 3666 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 3667 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 3668 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3669 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 3670 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 3671 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 3672 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 3673 * 3674 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 3675 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 3676 * to a merge. 3677 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3678 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 3679 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3680 * 3681 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 3682 * MESH mode) 3683 * 3684 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 3685 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 3686 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 3687 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 3688 * 3689 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 3690 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 3691 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 3692 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 3693 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 3694 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 3695 * return 0 if successful 3696 * 3697 * @set_wds_peer: set the WDS peer for a WDS interface 3698 * 3699 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 3700 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 3701 * 3702 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 3703 * 3704 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 3705 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 3706 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 3707 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 3708 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 3709 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 3710 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 3711 * the duration value. 3712 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 3713 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 3714 * frame on another channel 3715 * 3716 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 3717 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 3718 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 3719 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 3720 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 3721 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 3722 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 3723 * 3724 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 3725 * 3726 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 3727 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 3728 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 3729 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 3730 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 3731 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 3732 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 3733 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 3734 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 3735 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 3736 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 3737 * disabled.) 3738 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 3739 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 3740 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 3741 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 3742 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 3743 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 3744 * thresholds. 3745 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 3746 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 3747 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 3748 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 3749 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 3750 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 3751 * stop (when this method returns 0). 3752 * 3753 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 3754 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 3755 * 3756 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3757 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3758 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3759 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3760 * 3761 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3762 * 3763 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 3764 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 3765 * 3766 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 3767 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 3768 * 3769 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 3770 * 3771 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 3772 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 3773 * current monitoring channel. 3774 * 3775 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 3776 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 3777 * 3778 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 3779 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 3780 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 3781 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 3782 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 3783 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 3784 * 3785 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 3786 * 3787 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 3788 * was finished on another phy. 3789 * 3790 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 3791 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 3792 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 3793 * 3794 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 3795 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 3796 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 3797 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 3798 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 3799 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 3800 * 3801 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 3802 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 3803 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 3804 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 3805 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 3806 * as soon as possible. 3807 * 3808 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 3809 * 3810 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 3811 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 3812 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 3813 * 3814 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 3815 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 3816 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 3817 * account. 3818 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 3819 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 3820 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 3821 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 3822 * rejected) 3823 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 3824 * 3825 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 3826 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3827 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 3828 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3829 * 3830 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 3831 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 3832 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 3833 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 3834 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 3835 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 3836 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 3837 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 3838 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 3839 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 3840 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 3841 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 3842 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 3843 * provided @nan_func. 3844 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 3845 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 3846 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 3847 * All other parameters must be ignored. 3848 * 3849 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 3850 * 3851 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 3852 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 3853 * 3854 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 3855 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 3856 * upon which the driver should clear it. 3857 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3858 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 3859 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3860 * 3861 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 3862 * user space 3863 * 3864 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 3865 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 3866 * 3867 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 3868 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 3869 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 3870 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 3871 * 3872 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 3873 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 3874 * DH IE through this interface. 3875 * 3876 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 3877 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 3878 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 3879 * This callback may sleep. 3880 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 3881 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 3882 */ 3883 struct cfg80211_ops { 3884 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 3885 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 3886 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 3887 3888 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3889 const char *name, 3890 unsigned char name_assign_type, 3891 enum nl80211_iftype type, 3892 struct vif_params *params); 3893 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3894 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 3895 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3896 struct net_device *dev, 3897 enum nl80211_iftype type, 3898 struct vif_params *params); 3899 3900 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3901 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 3902 struct key_params *params); 3903 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3904 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 3905 void *cookie, 3906 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 3907 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3908 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr); 3909 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3910 struct net_device *netdev, 3911 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 3912 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3913 struct net_device *netdev, 3914 u8 key_index); 3915 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3916 struct net_device *netdev, 3917 u8 key_index); 3918 3919 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3920 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 3921 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3922 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info); 3923 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 3924 3925 3926 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3927 const u8 *mac, 3928 struct station_parameters *params); 3929 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3930 struct station_del_parameters *params); 3931 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3932 const u8 *mac, 3933 struct station_parameters *params); 3934 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3935 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 3936 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3937 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 3938 3939 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3940 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 3941 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3942 const u8 *dst); 3943 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3944 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 3945 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3946 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3947 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3948 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 3949 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3950 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3951 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3952 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3953 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 3954 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3955 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3956 struct net_device *dev, 3957 struct mesh_config *conf); 3958 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3959 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 3960 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 3961 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3962 const struct mesh_config *conf, 3963 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 3964 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 3965 3966 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3967 struct ocb_setup *setup); 3968 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 3969 3970 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3971 struct bss_parameters *params); 3972 3973 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3974 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 3975 3976 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3977 struct net_device *dev, 3978 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 3979 3980 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3981 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 3982 3983 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3984 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 3985 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 3986 3987 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3988 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 3989 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3990 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 3991 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3992 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 3993 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3994 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 3995 3996 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3997 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 3998 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3999 struct net_device *dev, 4000 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4001 u32 changed); 4002 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4003 u16 reason_code); 4004 4005 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4006 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4007 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4008 4009 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4010 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4011 4012 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4013 4014 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4015 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4016 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4017 int *dbm); 4018 4019 int (*set_wds_peer)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4020 const u8 *addr); 4021 4022 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4023 4024 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4025 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4026 void *data, int len); 4027 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4028 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4029 void *data, int len); 4030 #endif 4031 4032 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4033 struct net_device *dev, 4034 const u8 *peer, 4035 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4036 4037 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4038 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4039 4040 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4041 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4042 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4043 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4044 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4045 4046 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4047 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4048 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4049 unsigned int duration, 4050 u64 *cookie); 4051 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4052 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4053 u64 cookie); 4054 4055 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4056 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4057 u64 *cookie); 4058 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4059 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4060 u64 cookie); 4061 4062 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4063 bool enabled, int timeout); 4064 4065 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4066 struct net_device *dev, 4067 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4068 4069 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4070 struct net_device *dev, 4071 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4072 4073 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4074 struct net_device *dev, 4075 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4076 4077 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4078 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4079 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4080 4081 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4082 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4083 4084 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4085 struct net_device *dev, 4086 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4087 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4088 u64 reqid); 4089 4090 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4091 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4092 4093 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4094 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, 4095 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability, 4096 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4097 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4098 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4099 4100 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4101 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4102 4103 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4104 struct net_device *dev, 4105 u16 noack_map); 4106 4107 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4108 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4109 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4110 4111 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4112 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4113 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4114 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4115 4116 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4117 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4118 4119 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4120 struct net_device *dev, 4121 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4122 u32 cac_time_ms); 4123 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4124 struct net_device *dev); 4125 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4126 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4127 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4128 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4129 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4130 u16 duration); 4131 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4132 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4133 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4134 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4135 4136 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4137 struct net_device *dev, 4138 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4139 4140 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4141 struct net_device *dev, 4142 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4143 4144 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4145 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4146 4147 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4148 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4149 u16 admitted_time); 4150 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4151 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4152 4153 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4154 struct net_device *dev, 4155 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4156 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4157 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4158 struct net_device *dev, 4159 const u8 *addr); 4160 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4161 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4162 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4163 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4164 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4165 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4166 u64 cookie); 4167 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4168 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4169 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4170 u32 changes); 4171 4172 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4173 struct net_device *dev, 4174 const bool enabled); 4175 4176 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4177 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4178 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4179 4180 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4181 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4182 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4183 const u8 *aa); 4184 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4185 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4186 4187 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4188 struct net_device *dev, 4189 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4190 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4191 const bool noencrypt, 4192 u64 *cookie); 4193 4194 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4195 struct net_device *dev, 4196 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4197 4198 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4199 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4200 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4201 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4202 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4203 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4204 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4205 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4206 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4207 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4208 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4209 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4210 }; 4211 4212 /* 4213 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4214 * and registration/helper functions 4215 */ 4216 4217 /** 4218 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4219 * 4220 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4221 * wiphy at all 4222 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4223 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4224 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4225 * reason to override the default 4226 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4227 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4228 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4229 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4230 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4231 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4232 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4233 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4234 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4235 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4236 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4237 * firmware. 4238 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4239 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4240 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4241 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4242 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4243 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4244 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4245 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4246 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4247 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4248 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4249 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4250 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4251 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4252 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4253 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4254 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4255 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4256 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation 4257 * before connection. 4258 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4259 */ 4260 enum wiphy_flags { 4261 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4262 /* use hole at 1 */ 4263 /* use hole at 2 */ 4264 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4265 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4266 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4267 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4268 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4269 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4270 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4271 /* use hole at 11 */ 4272 /* use hole at 12 */ 4273 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4274 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4275 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4276 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4277 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4278 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4279 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4280 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4281 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4282 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4283 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4284 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24), 4285 }; 4286 4287 /** 4288 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4289 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4290 * @types: interface types (bits) 4291 */ 4292 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4293 u16 max; 4294 u16 types; 4295 }; 4296 4297 /** 4298 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4299 * 4300 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4301 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4302 * 4303 * Examples: 4304 * 4305 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4306 * 4307 * .. code-block:: c 4308 * 4309 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4310 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4311 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, }, 4312 * }; 4313 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4314 * .limits = limits1, 4315 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4316 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4317 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4318 * }; 4319 * 4320 * 4321 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4322 * 4323 * .. code-block:: c 4324 * 4325 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4326 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4327 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4328 * }; 4329 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4330 * .limits = limits2, 4331 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4332 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4333 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4334 * }; 4335 * 4336 * 4337 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4338 * 4339 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4340 * 4341 * .. code-block:: c 4342 * 4343 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 4344 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4345 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 4346 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 4347 * }; 4348 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 4349 * .limits = limits3, 4350 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 4351 * .max_interfaces = 4, 4352 * .num_different_channels = 2, 4353 * }; 4354 * 4355 */ 4356 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 4357 /** 4358 * @limits: 4359 * limits for the given interface types 4360 */ 4361 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 4362 4363 /** 4364 * @num_different_channels: 4365 * can use up to this many different channels 4366 */ 4367 u32 num_different_channels; 4368 4369 /** 4370 * @max_interfaces: 4371 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 4372 */ 4373 u16 max_interfaces; 4374 4375 /** 4376 * @n_limits: 4377 * number of limitations 4378 */ 4379 u8 n_limits; 4380 4381 /** 4382 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 4383 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 4384 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 4385 */ 4386 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 4387 4388 /** 4389 * @radar_detect_widths: 4390 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 4391 */ 4392 u8 radar_detect_widths; 4393 4394 /** 4395 * @radar_detect_regions: 4396 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 4397 */ 4398 u8 radar_detect_regions; 4399 4400 /** 4401 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 4402 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 4403 * 4404 * = 0 4405 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 4406 * > 0 4407 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 4408 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 4409 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 4410 */ 4411 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 4412 }; 4413 4414 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 4415 u16 tx, rx; 4416 }; 4417 4418 /** 4419 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 4420 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 4421 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 4422 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 4423 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 4424 * packet should be preserved in that case 4425 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 4426 * (see nl80211.h) 4427 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 4428 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 4429 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 4430 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 4431 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 4432 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 4433 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 4434 */ 4435 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 4436 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 4437 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 4438 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 4439 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 4440 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 4441 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 4442 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 4443 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 4444 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 4445 }; 4446 4447 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 4448 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 4449 u32 data_payload_max; 4450 u32 data_interval_max; 4451 u32 wake_payload_max; 4452 bool seq; 4453 }; 4454 4455 /** 4456 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 4457 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 4458 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 4459 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4460 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4461 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4462 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4463 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 4464 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 4465 * scheduled scans. 4466 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 4467 * details. 4468 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 4469 */ 4470 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 4471 u32 flags; 4472 int n_patterns; 4473 int pattern_max_len; 4474 int pattern_min_len; 4475 int max_pkt_offset; 4476 int max_nd_match_sets; 4477 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 4478 }; 4479 4480 /** 4481 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 4482 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 4483 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 4484 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 4485 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4486 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4487 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4488 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4489 */ 4490 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 4491 int n_rules; 4492 int max_delay; 4493 int n_patterns; 4494 int pattern_max_len; 4495 int pattern_min_len; 4496 int max_pkt_offset; 4497 }; 4498 4499 /** 4500 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 4501 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 4502 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 4503 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 4504 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 4505 */ 4506 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 4507 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 4508 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 4509 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 4510 }; 4511 4512 /** 4513 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 4514 * 4515 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 4516 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 4517 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 4518 * 4519 */ 4520 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 4521 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 4522 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 4523 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 4524 }; 4525 4526 /** 4527 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 4528 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 4529 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 4530 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 4531 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 4532 */ 4533 4534 struct sta_opmode_info { 4535 u32 changed; 4536 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 4537 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 4538 u8 rx_nss; 4539 }; 4540 4541 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 4542 4543 /** 4544 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 4545 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 4546 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 4547 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 4548 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 4549 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 4550 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 4551 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 4552 * dumpit calls. 4553 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 4554 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 4555 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 4556 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 4557 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 4558 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 4559 * are used with dump requests. 4560 */ 4561 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 4562 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 4563 u32 flags; 4564 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4565 const void *data, int data_len); 4566 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4567 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 4568 unsigned long *storage); 4569 const struct nla_policy *policy; 4570 unsigned int maxattr; 4571 }; 4572 4573 /** 4574 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 4575 * @iftype: interface type 4576 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4577 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 4578 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 4579 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 4580 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 4581 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4582 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4583 */ 4584 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 4585 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 4586 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 4587 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 4588 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4589 }; 4590 4591 /** 4592 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 4593 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 4594 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 4595 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 4596 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 4597 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 4598 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 4599 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 4600 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 4601 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 4602 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 4603 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 4604 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 4605 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 4606 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 4607 * not limited) 4608 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4609 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4610 */ 4611 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 4612 unsigned int max_peers; 4613 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 4614 randomize_mac_addr:1; 4615 4616 struct { 4617 u32 preambles; 4618 u32 bandwidths; 4619 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 4620 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 4621 u8 supported:1, 4622 asap:1, 4623 non_asap:1, 4624 request_lci:1, 4625 request_civicloc:1, 4626 trigger_based:1, 4627 non_trigger_based:1; 4628 } ftm; 4629 }; 4630 4631 /** 4632 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 4633 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 4634 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 4635 * 4636 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 4637 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 4638 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4639 */ 4640 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 4641 u16 iftypes_mask; 4642 const u32 *akm_suites; 4643 int n_akm_suites; 4644 }; 4645 4646 /** 4647 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 4648 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 4649 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 4650 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 4651 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 4652 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 4653 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 4654 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 4655 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 4656 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 4657 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 4658 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 4659 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 4660 * iftype_akm_suites. 4661 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4662 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 4663 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 4664 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 4665 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 4666 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 4667 * suites are specified separately. 4668 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 4669 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 4670 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 4671 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 4672 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 4673 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 4674 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 4675 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 4676 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 4677 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 4678 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 4679 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 4680 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 4681 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 4682 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 4683 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 4684 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 4685 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 4686 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 4687 * unregister hardware 4688 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 4689 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 4690 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 4691 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 4692 * (see below). 4693 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 4694 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 4695 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 4696 * must be set by driver 4697 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 4698 * list single interface types. 4699 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 4700 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 4701 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 4702 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 4703 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 4704 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 4705 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 4706 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 4707 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 4708 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 4709 * this variable determines its size 4710 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 4711 * any given scan 4712 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 4713 * the device can run concurrently. 4714 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 4715 * for in any given scheduled scan 4716 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 4717 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 4718 * supported. 4719 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 4720 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 4721 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 4722 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 4723 * scans 4724 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 4725 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 4726 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 4727 * single scan plan supported by the device. 4728 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 4729 * scan plan supported by the device. 4730 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 4731 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 4732 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 4733 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 4734 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 4735 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 4736 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 4737 * 4738 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 4739 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 4740 * type 4741 * 4742 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4743 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4744 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 4745 * 4746 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4747 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4748 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 4749 * 4750 * @probe_resp_offload: 4751 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 4752 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 4753 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 4754 * 4755 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 4756 * may request, if implemented. 4757 * 4758 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 4759 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 4760 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 4761 * to the suspend() operation instead. 4762 * 4763 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 4764 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 4765 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4766 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 4767 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4768 * 4769 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 4770 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 4771 * 4772 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 4773 * supports for ACL. 4774 * 4775 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4776 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 4777 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 4778 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 4779 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 4780 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 4781 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 4782 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4783 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4784 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 4785 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 4786 * capabilities are specified separately. 4787 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 4788 * 4789 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 4790 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 4791 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 4792 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 4793 * 4794 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 4795 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 4796 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 4797 * some cases, but may not always reach. 4798 * 4799 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 4800 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 4801 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 4802 * infinite. 4803 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 4804 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 4805 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 4806 * 4807 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 4808 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 4809 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 4810 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 4811 * 4812 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 4813 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 4814 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 4815 * 4816 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 4817 * wake_tx_queue 4818 * 4819 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 4820 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 4821 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 4822 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 4823 * 4824 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 4825 * 4826 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 4827 * device has 4828 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4829 * supported by the driver for each vif 4830 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4831 * supported by the driver for each peer 4832 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 4833 * long/short retry configuration 4834 * 4835 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 4836 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 4837 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 4838 */ 4839 struct wiphy { 4840 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 4841 4842 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4843 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 4844 4845 struct mac_address *addresses; 4846 4847 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 4848 4849 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 4850 int n_iface_combinations; 4851 u16 software_iftypes; 4852 4853 u16 n_addresses; 4854 4855 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 4856 u16 interface_modes; 4857 4858 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 4859 4860 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 4861 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 4862 4863 u32 ap_sme_capa; 4864 4865 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 4866 4867 int bss_priv_size; 4868 u8 max_scan_ssids; 4869 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 4870 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 4871 u8 max_match_sets; 4872 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 4873 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 4874 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 4875 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 4876 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 4877 4878 int n_cipher_suites; 4879 const u32 *cipher_suites; 4880 4881 int n_akm_suites; 4882 const u32 *akm_suites; 4883 4884 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 4885 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 4886 4887 u8 retry_short; 4888 u8 retry_long; 4889 u32 frag_threshold; 4890 u32 rts_threshold; 4891 u8 coverage_class; 4892 4893 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 4894 u32 hw_version; 4895 4896 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4897 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 4898 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 4899 #endif 4900 4901 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 4902 4903 u8 max_num_pmkids; 4904 4905 u32 available_antennas_tx; 4906 u32 available_antennas_rx; 4907 4908 u32 probe_resp_offload; 4909 4910 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 4911 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4912 4913 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 4914 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 4915 4916 const void *privid; 4917 4918 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 4919 4920 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4921 struct regulatory_request *request); 4922 4923 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 4924 4925 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 4926 4927 struct device dev; 4928 4929 bool registered; 4930 4931 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 4932 4933 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 4934 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 4935 4936 struct list_head wdev_list; 4937 4938 possible_net_t _net; 4939 4940 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 4941 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 4942 #endif 4943 4944 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 4945 4946 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 4947 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 4948 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 4949 4950 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 4951 4952 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 4953 4954 u32 bss_select_support; 4955 4956 u8 nan_supported_bands; 4957 4958 u32 txq_limit; 4959 u32 txq_memory_limit; 4960 u32 txq_quantum; 4961 4962 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 4963 4964 u8 support_mbssid:1, 4965 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 4966 4967 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 4968 4969 struct { 4970 u64 peer, vif; 4971 u8 max_retry; 4972 } tid_config_support; 4973 4974 u8 max_data_retry_count; 4975 4976 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 4977 }; 4978 4979 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 4980 { 4981 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 4982 } 4983 4984 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 4985 { 4986 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 4987 } 4988 4989 /** 4990 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 4991 * 4992 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 4993 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 4994 */ 4995 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 4996 { 4997 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 4998 return &wiphy->priv; 4999 } 5000 5001 /** 5002 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5003 * 5004 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5005 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5006 */ 5007 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5008 { 5009 BUG_ON(!priv); 5010 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5011 } 5012 5013 /** 5014 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5015 * 5016 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5017 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5018 */ 5019 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5020 { 5021 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5022 } 5023 5024 /** 5025 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5026 * 5027 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5028 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5029 */ 5030 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5031 { 5032 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5033 } 5034 5035 /** 5036 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5037 * 5038 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5039 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5040 */ 5041 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5042 { 5043 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5044 } 5045 5046 /** 5047 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5048 * 5049 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5050 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5051 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5052 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5053 * 5054 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5055 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5056 * 5057 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5058 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5059 */ 5060 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5061 const char *requested_name); 5062 5063 /** 5064 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5065 * 5066 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5067 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5068 * 5069 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5070 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5071 * 5072 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5073 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5074 */ 5075 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5076 int sizeof_priv) 5077 { 5078 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5079 } 5080 5081 /** 5082 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5083 * 5084 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5085 * 5086 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5087 */ 5088 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5089 5090 /** 5091 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5092 * 5093 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5094 * 5095 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5096 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5097 * request that is being handled. 5098 */ 5099 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5100 5101 /** 5102 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5103 * 5104 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5105 */ 5106 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5107 5108 /* internal structs */ 5109 struct cfg80211_conn; 5110 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5111 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5112 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5113 5114 /** 5115 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5116 * 5117 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5118 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5119 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5120 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5121 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device. 5122 * 5123 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 5124 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 5125 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 5126 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 5127 * 5128 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 5129 * @iftype: interface type 5130 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 5131 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 5132 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 5133 * wireless device if it has no netdev 5134 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5135 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track 5136 * the user-set channel definition. 5137 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to 5138 * track the channel to be used for AP later 5139 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5140 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5141 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5142 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5143 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5144 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 5145 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 5146 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 5147 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 5148 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 5149 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 5150 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 5151 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 5152 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 5153 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 5154 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 5155 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 5156 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 5157 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 5158 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 5159 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 5160 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 5161 * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list 5162 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 5163 * need to propagate the update to the driver 5164 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers 5165 * and some API functions require it held 5166 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 5167 * beacons, 0 when not valid 5168 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 5169 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 5170 * the P2P Device. 5171 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 5172 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 5173 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 5174 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 5175 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 5176 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 5177 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 5178 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 5179 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 5180 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 5181 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 5182 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 5183 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 5184 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID 5185 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel 5186 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 5187 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 5188 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 5189 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 5190 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 5191 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 5192 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 5193 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 5194 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 5195 * unprotected beacon report 5196 */ 5197 struct wireless_dev { 5198 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5199 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5200 5201 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 5202 struct list_head list; 5203 struct net_device *netdev; 5204 5205 u32 identifier; 5206 5207 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 5208 spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock; 5209 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 5210 5211 struct mutex mtx; 5212 5213 bool use_4addr, is_running; 5214 5215 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 5216 5217 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 5218 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5219 u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len; 5220 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 5221 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 5222 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 5223 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 5224 5225 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 5226 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5227 5228 struct list_head event_list; 5229 spinlock_t event_lock; 5230 5231 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */ 5232 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 5233 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 5234 5235 bool ibss_fixed; 5236 bool ibss_dfs_possible; 5237 5238 bool ps; 5239 int ps_timeout; 5240 5241 int beacon_interval; 5242 5243 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 5244 5245 u32 owner_nlportid; 5246 bool nl_owner_dead; 5247 5248 bool cac_started; 5249 unsigned long cac_start_time; 5250 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 5251 5252 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5253 /* wext data */ 5254 struct { 5255 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 5256 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 5257 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 5258 const u8 *ie; 5259 size_t ie_len; 5260 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5261 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5262 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5263 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 5264 bool prev_bssid_valid; 5265 } wext; 5266 #endif 5267 5268 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config; 5269 5270 struct list_head pmsr_list; 5271 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 5272 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 5273 5274 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 5275 }; 5276 5277 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5278 { 5279 if (wdev->netdev) 5280 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 5281 return wdev->address; 5282 } 5283 5284 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5285 { 5286 if (wdev->netdev) 5287 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 5288 return wdev->is_running; 5289 } 5290 5291 /** 5292 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 5293 * 5294 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 5295 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 5296 */ 5297 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5298 { 5299 BUG_ON(!wdev); 5300 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 5301 } 5302 5303 /** 5304 * DOC: Utility functions 5305 * 5306 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 5307 */ 5308 5309 /** 5310 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 5311 * 5312 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 5313 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 5314 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 5315 */ 5316 static inline bool 5317 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 5318 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 5319 { 5320 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 5321 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 5322 } 5323 5324 /** 5325 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 5326 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 5327 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 5328 */ 5329 static inline u32 5330 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5331 { 5332 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 5333 } 5334 5335 /** 5336 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 5337 * 5338 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 5339 * @chan: channel 5340 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 5341 */ 5342 enum nl80211_chan_width 5343 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 5344 5345 /** 5346 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 5347 * @chan: channel number 5348 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5349 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5350 */ 5351 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 5352 5353 /** 5354 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 5355 * @chan: channel number 5356 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5357 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5358 */ 5359 static inline int 5360 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 5361 { 5362 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 5363 } 5364 5365 /** 5366 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5367 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 5368 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5369 */ 5370 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 5371 5372 /** 5373 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5374 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 5375 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5376 */ 5377 static inline int 5378 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 5379 { 5380 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5381 } 5382 5383 /** 5384 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 5385 * frequency 5386 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5387 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 5388 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5389 */ 5390 struct ieee80211_channel * 5391 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 5392 5393 /** 5394 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 5395 * 5396 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5397 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 5398 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5399 */ 5400 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 5401 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 5402 { 5403 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5404 } 5405 5406 /** 5407 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 5408 * @chan: control channel to check 5409 * 5410 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 5411 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 5412 */ 5413 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5414 { 5415 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 5416 return false; 5417 5418 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 5419 } 5420 5421 /** 5422 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 5423 * 5424 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5425 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 5426 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 5427 * 5428 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 5429 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 5430 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 5431 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 5432 */ 5433 struct ieee80211_rate * 5434 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5435 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 5436 5437 /** 5438 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 5439 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5440 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 5441 * 5442 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 5443 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 5444 */ 5445 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5446 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width); 5447 5448 /* 5449 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 5450 * 5451 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 5452 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 5453 */ 5454 5455 struct radiotap_align_size { 5456 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 5457 }; 5458 5459 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 5460 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 5461 int n_bits; 5462 uint32_t oui; 5463 uint8_t subns; 5464 }; 5465 5466 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 5467 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 5468 int n_ns; 5469 }; 5470 5471 /** 5472 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 5473 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 5474 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 5475 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 5476 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 5477 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 5478 * the beginning of the actual data portion 5479 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 5480 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 5481 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 5482 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 5483 * radiotap namespace or not 5484 * 5485 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 5486 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 5487 * @_arg_index: next argument index 5488 * @_arg: next argument pointer 5489 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 5490 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 5491 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 5492 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 5493 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 5494 * next bitmap word 5495 * 5496 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 5497 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 5498 */ 5499 5500 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 5501 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 5502 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 5503 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 5504 5505 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 5506 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 5507 5508 unsigned char *this_arg; 5509 int this_arg_index; 5510 int this_arg_size; 5511 5512 int is_radiotap_ns; 5513 5514 int _max_length; 5515 int _arg_index; 5516 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 5517 int _reset_on_ext; 5518 }; 5519 5520 int 5521 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 5522 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 5523 int max_length, 5524 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 5525 5526 int 5527 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 5528 5529 5530 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 5531 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 5532 5533 /** 5534 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 5535 * 5536 * @skb: the frame 5537 * 5538 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 5539 * returns the 802.11 header length. 5540 * 5541 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 5542 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 5543 * 802.11 header. 5544 */ 5545 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 5546 5547 /** 5548 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 5549 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 5550 * Return: The header length in bytes. 5551 */ 5552 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 5553 5554 /** 5555 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 5556 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 5557 * (first byte) will be accessed 5558 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 5559 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 5560 */ 5561 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 5562 5563 /** 5564 * DOC: Data path helpers 5565 * 5566 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 5567 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 5568 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 5569 */ 5570 5571 /** 5572 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5573 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5574 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 5575 * of it being pushed into the SKB 5576 * @addr: the device MAC address 5577 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5578 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 5579 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5580 */ 5581 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 5582 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5583 u8 data_offset); 5584 5585 /** 5586 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5587 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5588 * @addr: the device MAC address 5589 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5590 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5591 */ 5592 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 5593 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 5594 { 5595 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0); 5596 } 5597 5598 /** 5599 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 5600 * 5601 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 5602 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 5603 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 5604 * 5605 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 5606 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 5607 * initialized by the caller. 5608 * @addr: The device MAC address. 5609 * @iftype: The device interface type. 5610 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 5611 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5612 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5613 */ 5614 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 5615 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5616 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 5617 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa); 5618 5619 /** 5620 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 5621 * @skb: the data frame 5622 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 5623 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 5624 */ 5625 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 5626 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 5627 5628 /** 5629 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 5630 * 5631 * @eid: element ID 5632 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5633 * @len: length of data 5634 * @match: byte array to match 5635 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5636 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 5637 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 5638 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 5639 * the data portion instead. 5640 * 5641 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5642 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5643 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5644 * requested element struct. 5645 * 5646 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5647 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5648 * byte array to match. 5649 */ 5650 const struct element * 5651 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5652 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5653 unsigned int match_offset); 5654 5655 /** 5656 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 5657 * 5658 * @eid: element ID 5659 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5660 * @len: length of data 5661 * @match: byte array to match 5662 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5663 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 5664 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 5665 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 5666 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 5667 * the second byte is the IE length. 5668 * 5669 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5670 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5671 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 5672 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5673 * element ID. 5674 * 5675 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5676 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5677 * byte array to match. 5678 */ 5679 static inline const u8 * 5680 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5681 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5682 unsigned int match_offset) 5683 { 5684 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 5685 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 5686 */ 5687 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 5688 (!match_len && match_offset))) 5689 return NULL; 5690 5691 return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 5692 match, match_len, 5693 match_offset ? 5694 match_offset - 2 : 0); 5695 } 5696 5697 /** 5698 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 5699 * 5700 * @eid: element ID 5701 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5702 * @len: length of data 5703 * 5704 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5705 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5706 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5707 * requested element struct. 5708 * 5709 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5710 * having to fit into the given data. 5711 */ 5712 static inline const struct element * 5713 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5714 { 5715 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5716 } 5717 5718 /** 5719 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 5720 * 5721 * @eid: element ID 5722 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5723 * @len: length of data 5724 * 5725 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5726 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5727 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5728 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5729 * 5730 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5731 * having to fit into the given data. 5732 */ 5733 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5734 { 5735 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5736 } 5737 5738 /** 5739 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 5740 * 5741 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5742 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5743 * @len: length of data 5744 * 5745 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if 5746 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5747 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5748 * requested element struct. 5749 * 5750 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5751 * having to fit into the given data. 5752 */ 5753 static inline const struct element * 5754 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5755 { 5756 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5757 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 5758 } 5759 5760 /** 5761 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 5762 * 5763 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5764 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5765 * @len: length of data 5766 * 5767 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 5768 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5769 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5770 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5771 * 5772 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5773 * having to fit into the given data. 5774 */ 5775 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5776 { 5777 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5778 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 5779 } 5780 5781 /** 5782 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 5783 * 5784 * @oui: vendor OUI 5785 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5786 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5787 * @len: length of data 5788 * 5789 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5790 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 5791 * return the element structure for the requested element. 5792 * 5793 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5794 * the given data. 5795 */ 5796 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5797 const u8 *ies, 5798 unsigned int len); 5799 5800 /** 5801 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 5802 * 5803 * @oui: vendor OUI 5804 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5805 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5806 * @len: length of data 5807 * 5808 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5809 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 5810 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5811 * element ID. 5812 * 5813 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5814 * the given data. 5815 */ 5816 static inline const u8 * 5817 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5818 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 5819 { 5820 return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 5821 } 5822 5823 /** 5824 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 5825 * 5826 * @dev: network device 5827 * @addr: STA MAC address 5828 * 5829 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 5830 * devices upon STA association. 5831 */ 5832 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 5833 5834 /** 5835 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 5836 * 5837 * TODO 5838 */ 5839 5840 /** 5841 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 5842 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 5843 * conflicts) 5844 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 5845 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 5846 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 5847 * alpha2. 5848 * 5849 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 5850 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 5851 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 5852 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 5853 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 5854 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 5855 * 5856 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 5857 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 5858 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 5859 * 5860 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 5861 * an -ENOMEM. 5862 * 5863 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 5864 */ 5865 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 5866 5867 /** 5868 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 5869 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5870 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy 5871 * 5872 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 5873 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 5874 * information. 5875 * 5876 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 5877 */ 5878 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5879 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 5880 5881 /** 5882 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl - set regdom for self-managed drivers 5883 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5884 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 5885 * 5886 * This functions requires the RTNL to be held and applies the new regdomain 5887 * synchronously to this wiphy. For more details see 5888 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 5889 * 5890 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 5891 */ 5892 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5893 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 5894 5895 /** 5896 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 5897 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5898 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 5899 * 5900 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 5901 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 5902 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 5903 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 5904 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 5905 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 5906 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 5907 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 5908 * that called this helper. 5909 */ 5910 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5911 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 5912 5913 /** 5914 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 5915 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 5916 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 5917 * 5918 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 5919 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 5920 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 5921 * and processed already. 5922 * 5923 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 5924 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 5925 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 5926 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 5927 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 5928 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 5929 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 5930 */ 5931 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5932 u32 center_freq); 5933 5934 /** 5935 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 5936 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 5937 * 5938 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 5939 * proper string representation. 5940 */ 5941 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 5942 5943 /** 5944 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 5945 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 5946 * 5947 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 5948 */ 5949 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5950 5951 /** 5952 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 5953 * 5954 */ 5955 5956 /** 5957 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 5958 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 5959 * 5960 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 5961 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried. 5962 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 5963 * 5964 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 5965 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 5966 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 5967 * 5968 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 5969 * an -ENODATA. 5970 * 5971 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 5972 */ 5973 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 5974 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 5975 5976 /* 5977 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 5978 * functions and BSS handling helpers 5979 */ 5980 5981 /** 5982 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 5983 * 5984 * @request: the corresponding scan request 5985 * @info: information about the completed scan 5986 */ 5987 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 5988 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 5989 5990 /** 5991 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 5992 * 5993 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 5994 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 5995 */ 5996 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 5997 5998 /** 5999 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6000 * 6001 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6002 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6003 * 6004 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6005 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6006 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6007 */ 6008 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6009 6010 /** 6011 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6012 * 6013 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6014 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6015 * 6016 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6017 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6018 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6019 * This function should be called with rtnl locked. 6020 */ 6021 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6022 6023 /** 6024 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 6025 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6026 * @data: the BSS metadata 6027 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 6028 * @len: length of the management frame 6029 * @gfp: context flags 6030 * 6031 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6032 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6033 * 6034 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6035 * Or %NULL on error. 6036 */ 6037 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6038 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6039 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6040 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6041 gfp_t gfp); 6042 6043 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6044 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6045 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6046 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6047 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6048 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6049 { 6050 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6051 .chan = rx_channel, 6052 .scan_width = scan_width, 6053 .signal = signal, 6054 }; 6055 6056 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6057 } 6058 6059 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6060 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6061 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6062 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6063 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6064 { 6065 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6066 .chan = rx_channel, 6067 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6068 .signal = signal, 6069 }; 6070 6071 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6072 } 6073 6074 /** 6075 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 6076 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 6077 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 6078 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 6079 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 6080 */ 6081 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 6082 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 6083 { 6084 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 6085 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 6086 u64 new_bssid_u64; 6087 6088 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 6089 6090 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 6091 6092 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 6093 } 6094 6095 /** 6096 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 6097 * @element: element to check 6098 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 6099 */ 6100 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 6101 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 6102 6103 /** 6104 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 6105 * @ie: ies 6106 * @ielen: length of IEs 6107 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 6108 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 6109 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 6110 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 6111 */ 6112 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6113 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 6114 const struct element *sub_elem, 6115 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 6116 6117 /** 6118 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 6119 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 6120 * from a beacon or probe response 6121 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 6122 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 6123 */ 6124 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 6125 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 6126 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 6127 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 6128 }; 6129 6130 /** 6131 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 6132 * 6133 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6134 * @data: the BSS metadata 6135 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 6136 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 6137 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 6138 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 6139 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 6140 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 6141 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 6142 * @gfp: context flags 6143 * 6144 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6145 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6146 * 6147 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6148 * Or %NULL on error. 6149 */ 6150 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6151 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6152 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6153 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6154 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6155 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6156 gfp_t gfp); 6157 6158 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6159 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6160 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6161 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6162 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6163 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6164 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6165 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6166 { 6167 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6168 .chan = rx_channel, 6169 .scan_width = scan_width, 6170 .signal = signal, 6171 }; 6172 6173 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6174 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6175 gfp); 6176 } 6177 6178 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6179 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6180 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6181 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6182 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6183 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6184 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6185 { 6186 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6187 .chan = rx_channel, 6188 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6189 .signal = signal, 6190 }; 6191 6192 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6193 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6194 gfp); 6195 } 6196 6197 /** 6198 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 6199 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6200 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 6201 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 6202 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 6203 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 6204 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 6205 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 6206 */ 6207 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6208 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6209 const u8 *bssid, 6210 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 6211 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 6212 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 6213 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 6214 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6215 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6216 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 6217 { 6218 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 6219 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 6220 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 6221 } 6222 6223 /** 6224 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 6225 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6226 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 6227 * 6228 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6229 */ 6230 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6231 6232 /** 6233 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 6234 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6235 * @bss: the BSS struct 6236 * 6237 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6238 */ 6239 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6240 6241 /** 6242 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 6243 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6244 * @bss: the bss to remove 6245 * 6246 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 6247 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 6248 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 6249 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 6250 */ 6251 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6252 6253 /** 6254 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 6255 * 6256 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 6257 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 6258 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 6259 * 6260 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6261 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 6262 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 6263 * @iter: the iterator function to call 6264 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 6265 */ 6266 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6267 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6268 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6269 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6270 void *data), 6271 void *iter_data); 6272 6273 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width 6274 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 6275 { 6276 switch (chandef->width) { 6277 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 6278 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5; 6279 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 6280 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10; 6281 default: 6282 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6283 } 6284 } 6285 6286 /** 6287 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 6288 * @dev: network device 6289 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 6290 * @len: length of the frame data 6291 * 6292 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 6293 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 6294 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 6295 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6296 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6297 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6298 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 6299 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 6300 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 6301 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 6302 * 6303 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6304 */ 6305 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6306 6307 /** 6308 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 6309 * @dev: network device 6310 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 6311 * 6312 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 6313 * mutex. 6314 */ 6315 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6316 6317 /** 6318 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 6319 * @dev: network device 6320 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 6321 * moves to cfg80211 in this call 6322 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 6323 * @len: length of the frame data 6324 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 6325 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 6326 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 6327 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 6328 * 6329 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6330 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6331 * 6332 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6333 */ 6334 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 6335 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6336 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6337 int uapsd_queues, 6338 const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len); 6339 6340 /** 6341 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association 6342 * @dev: network device 6343 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out. 6344 * 6345 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6346 */ 6347 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6348 6349 /** 6350 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt 6351 * @dev: network device 6352 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned. 6353 * 6354 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX, 6355 * an association attempt was abandoned. 6356 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6357 */ 6358 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6359 6360 /** 6361 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 6362 * @dev: network device 6363 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 6364 * @len: length of the frame data 6365 * 6366 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 6367 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 6368 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 6369 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 6370 */ 6371 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6372 6373 /** 6374 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 6375 * @dev: network device 6376 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 6377 * @len: length of the frame data 6378 * 6379 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 6380 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 6381 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 6382 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 6383 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 6384 * 6385 * This function may sleep. 6386 */ 6387 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 6388 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6389 6390 /** 6391 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 6392 * @dev: network device 6393 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 6394 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 6395 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 6396 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 6397 * @gfp: allocation flags 6398 * 6399 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 6400 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 6401 * primitive. 6402 */ 6403 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 6404 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 6405 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 6406 6407 /** 6408 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 6409 * 6410 * @dev: network device 6411 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 6412 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 6413 * @gfp: allocation flags 6414 * 6415 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 6416 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 6417 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 6418 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 6419 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 6420 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 6421 */ 6422 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6423 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 6424 6425 /** 6426 * cfg80211_notify_new_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer candidate 6427 * 6428 * @dev: network device 6429 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 6430 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 6431 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 6432 * @gfp: allocation flags 6433 * 6434 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 6435 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 6436 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 6437 */ 6438 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 6439 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 6440 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 6441 6442 /** 6443 * DOC: RFkill integration 6444 * 6445 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 6446 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 6447 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 6448 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 6449 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 6450 * 6451 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 6452 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 6453 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 6454 */ 6455 6456 /** 6457 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 6458 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6459 * @blocked: block status 6460 */ 6461 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked); 6462 6463 /** 6464 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 6465 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6466 */ 6467 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6468 6469 /** 6470 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 6471 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6472 */ 6473 void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6474 6475 /** 6476 * DOC: Vendor commands 6477 * 6478 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 6479 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 6480 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 6481 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 6482 * the configuration mechanism. 6483 * 6484 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 6485 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 6486 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 6487 * 6488 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 6489 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 6490 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 6491 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 6492 * managers etc. need. 6493 */ 6494 6495 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6496 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6497 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6498 int approxlen); 6499 6500 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6501 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6502 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6503 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6504 unsigned int portid, 6505 int vendor_event_idx, 6506 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 6507 6508 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 6509 6510 /** 6511 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 6512 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6513 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6514 * be put into the skb 6515 * 6516 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6517 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6518 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 6519 * 6520 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 6521 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6522 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6523 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6524 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6525 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 6526 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 6527 * 6528 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 6529 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 6530 * 6531 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6532 */ 6533 static inline struct sk_buff * 6534 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6535 { 6536 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6537 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 6538 } 6539 6540 /** 6541 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 6542 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6543 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 6544 * 6545 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6546 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 6547 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 6548 * skb regardless of the return value. 6549 * 6550 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6551 */ 6552 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 6553 6554 /** 6555 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender 6556 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6557 * 6558 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 6559 * Valid to call only there. 6560 */ 6561 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6562 6563 /** 6564 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 6565 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6566 * @wdev: the wireless device 6567 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6568 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6569 * be put into the skb 6570 * @gfp: allocation flags 6571 * 6572 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6573 * vendor-specific multicast group. 6574 * 6575 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6576 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6577 * attribute. 6578 * 6579 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6580 * skb to send the event. 6581 * 6582 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6583 */ 6584 static inline struct sk_buff * 6585 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6586 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6587 { 6588 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6589 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6590 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6591 } 6592 6593 /** 6594 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 6595 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6596 * @wdev: the wireless device 6597 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6598 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 6599 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6600 * be put into the skb 6601 * @gfp: allocation flags 6602 * 6603 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 6604 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 6605 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 6606 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 6607 * 6608 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6609 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6610 * attribute. 6611 * 6612 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6613 * skb to send the event. 6614 * 6615 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6616 */ 6617 static inline struct sk_buff * 6618 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6619 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6620 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 6621 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6622 { 6623 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6624 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6625 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6626 } 6627 6628 /** 6629 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 6630 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 6631 * @gfp: allocation flags 6632 * 6633 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6634 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 6635 */ 6636 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6637 { 6638 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6639 } 6640 6641 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 6642 /** 6643 * DOC: Test mode 6644 * 6645 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 6646 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 6647 * factory programming. 6648 * 6649 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 6650 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 6651 */ 6652 6653 /** 6654 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 6655 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6656 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6657 * be put into the skb 6658 * 6659 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6660 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6661 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 6662 * 6663 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 6664 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6665 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6666 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6667 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6668 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 6669 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 6670 * 6671 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 6672 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 6673 * 6674 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6675 */ 6676 static inline struct sk_buff * 6677 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6678 { 6679 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6680 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 6681 } 6682 6683 /** 6684 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 6685 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6686 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 6687 * 6688 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6689 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 6690 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 6691 * regardless of the return value. 6692 * 6693 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6694 */ 6695 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 6696 { 6697 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 6698 } 6699 6700 /** 6701 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 6702 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6703 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6704 * be put into the skb 6705 * @gfp: allocation flags 6706 * 6707 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6708 * testmode multicast group. 6709 * 6710 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 6711 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 6712 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 6713 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 6714 * in any other way. 6715 * 6716 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 6717 * skb to send the event. 6718 * 6719 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6720 */ 6721 static inline struct sk_buff * 6722 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 6723 { 6724 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6725 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 6726 approxlen, gfp); 6727 } 6728 6729 /** 6730 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 6731 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6732 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 6733 * @gfp: allocation flags 6734 * 6735 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6736 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 6737 * consumes it. 6738 */ 6739 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6740 { 6741 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6742 } 6743 6744 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 6745 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 6746 #else 6747 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 6748 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 6749 #endif 6750 6751 /** 6752 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 6753 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 6754 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 6755 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 6756 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 6757 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 6758 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 6759 * status for a FILS connection. 6760 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6761 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 6762 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 6763 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6764 */ 6765 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 6766 const u8 *kek; 6767 size_t kek_len; 6768 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 6769 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 6770 const u8 *pmk; 6771 size_t pmk_len; 6772 const u8 *pmkid; 6773 }; 6774 6775 /** 6776 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 6777 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6778 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6779 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6780 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6781 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6782 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6783 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6784 * case. 6785 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL) 6786 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6787 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6788 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6789 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6790 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6791 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6792 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 6793 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 6794 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6795 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 6796 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 6797 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 6798 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 6799 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 6800 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 6801 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 6802 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 6803 */ 6804 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 6805 int status; 6806 const u8 *bssid; 6807 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 6808 const u8 *req_ie; 6809 size_t req_ie_len; 6810 const u8 *resp_ie; 6811 size_t resp_ie_len; 6812 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 6813 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 6814 }; 6815 6816 /** 6817 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6818 * 6819 * @dev: network device 6820 * @params: connection response parameters 6821 * @gfp: allocation flags 6822 * 6823 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6824 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6825 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 6826 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 6827 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 6828 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6829 */ 6830 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 6831 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 6832 gfp_t gfp); 6833 6834 /** 6835 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6836 * 6837 * @dev: network device 6838 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6839 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6840 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6841 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6842 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6843 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6844 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6845 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6846 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6847 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6848 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 6849 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6850 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6851 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6852 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6853 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6854 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6855 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6856 * case. 6857 * @gfp: allocation flags 6858 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 6859 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 6860 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 6861 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 6862 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 6863 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 6864 * 6865 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6866 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6867 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 6868 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 6869 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6870 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6871 */ 6872 static inline void 6873 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6874 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 6875 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 6876 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 6877 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 6878 { 6879 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 6880 6881 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 6882 params.status = status; 6883 params.bssid = bssid; 6884 params.bss = bss; 6885 params.req_ie = req_ie; 6886 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 6887 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 6888 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 6889 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 6890 6891 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 6892 } 6893 6894 /** 6895 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6896 * 6897 * @dev: network device 6898 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6899 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6900 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6901 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6902 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 6903 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6904 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6905 * the real status code for failures. 6906 * @gfp: allocation flags 6907 * 6908 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6909 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6910 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 6911 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6912 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6913 */ 6914 static inline void 6915 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6916 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 6917 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 6918 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 6919 { 6920 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 6921 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 6922 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 6923 } 6924 6925 /** 6926 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 6927 * 6928 * @dev: network device 6929 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6930 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6931 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6932 * @gfp: allocation flags 6933 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 6934 * 6935 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 6936 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 6937 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 6938 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 6939 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 6940 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6941 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6942 */ 6943 static inline void 6944 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6945 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 6946 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 6947 { 6948 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 6949 gfp, timeout_reason); 6950 } 6951 6952 /** 6953 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 6954 * 6955 * @channel: the channel of the new AP 6956 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set) 6957 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set) 6958 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6959 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6960 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6961 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 6962 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 6963 */ 6964 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 6965 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 6966 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 6967 const u8 *bssid; 6968 const u8 *req_ie; 6969 size_t req_ie_len; 6970 const u8 *resp_ie; 6971 size_t resp_ie_len; 6972 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 6973 }; 6974 6975 /** 6976 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 6977 * 6978 * @dev: network device 6979 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 6980 * @gfp: allocation flags 6981 * 6982 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 6983 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 6984 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 6985 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 6986 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 6987 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 6988 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 6989 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 6990 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 6991 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 6992 */ 6993 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 6994 gfp_t gfp); 6995 6996 /** 6997 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 6998 * 6999 * @dev: network device 7000 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7001 * @gfp: allocation flags 7002 * 7003 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 7004 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 7005 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 7006 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 7007 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 7008 * indicate the 802.11 association. 7009 */ 7010 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7011 gfp_t gfp); 7012 7013 /** 7014 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 7015 * 7016 * @dev: network device 7017 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 7018 * @ie_len: length of IEs 7019 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 7020 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 7021 * @gfp: allocation flags 7022 * 7023 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 7024 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 7025 */ 7026 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 7027 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 7028 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 7029 7030 /** 7031 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 7032 * @wdev: wireless device 7033 * @cookie: the request cookie 7034 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7035 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 7036 * channel 7037 * @gfp: allocation flags 7038 */ 7039 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7040 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7041 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 7042 7043 /** 7044 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 7045 * @wdev: wireless device 7046 * @cookie: the request cookie 7047 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7048 * @gfp: allocation flags 7049 */ 7050 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7051 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7052 gfp_t gfp); 7053 7054 /** 7055 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 7056 * @wdev: wireless device 7057 * @cookie: the requested cookie 7058 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 7059 * @gfp: allocation flags 7060 */ 7061 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7062 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 7063 7064 /** 7065 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 7066 * 7067 * @sinfo: the station information 7068 * @gfp: allocation flags 7069 */ 7070 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7071 7072 /** 7073 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 7074 * @sinfo: the station information 7075 * 7076 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 7077 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 7078 * the stack.) 7079 */ 7080 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 7081 { 7082 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 7083 } 7084 7085 /** 7086 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 7087 * 7088 * @dev: the netdev 7089 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7090 * @sinfo: the station information 7091 * @gfp: allocation flags 7092 */ 7093 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7094 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7095 7096 /** 7097 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7098 * @dev: the netdev 7099 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7100 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 7101 * @gfp: allocation flags 7102 */ 7103 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7104 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7105 7106 /** 7107 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7108 * 7109 * @dev: the netdev 7110 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7111 * @gfp: allocation flags 7112 */ 7113 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 7114 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 7115 { 7116 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 7117 } 7118 7119 /** 7120 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 7121 * 7122 * @dev: the netdev 7123 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7124 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 7125 * @gfp: allocation flags 7126 * 7127 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 7128 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 7129 * for some reasons, this function is called. 7130 * 7131 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 7132 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 7133 */ 7134 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7135 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 7136 gfp_t gfp); 7137 7138 /** 7139 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7140 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7141 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 7142 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7143 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7144 * @len: length of the frame data 7145 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7146 * 7147 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7148 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7149 * 7150 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7151 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7152 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7153 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7154 */ 7155 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm, 7156 const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags); 7157 7158 /** 7159 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7160 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7161 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 7162 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7163 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7164 * @len: length of the frame data 7165 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7166 * 7167 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7168 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7169 * 7170 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7171 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7172 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7173 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7174 */ 7175 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 7176 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7177 u32 flags) 7178 { 7179 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len, 7180 flags); 7181 } 7182 7183 /** 7184 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 7185 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7186 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 7187 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7188 * @len: length of the frame data 7189 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7190 * @gfp: context flags 7191 * 7192 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 7193 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 7194 * transmission attempt. 7195 */ 7196 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7197 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp); 7198 7199 /** 7200 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 7201 * port frames 7202 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7203 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 7204 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 7205 * @len: length of the frame data 7206 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7207 * @gfp: context flags 7208 * 7209 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 7210 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 7211 * the transmission attempt. 7212 */ 7213 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7214 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 7215 gfp_t gfp); 7216 7217 /** 7218 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 7219 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7220 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 7221 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 7222 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 7223 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 7224 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 7225 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 7226 * 7227 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 7228 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 7229 * control port frames over nl80211. 7230 * 7231 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 7232 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 7233 * 7234 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 7235 */ 7236 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, 7237 struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted); 7238 7239 /** 7240 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 7241 * @dev: network device 7242 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 7243 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 7244 * @gfp: context flags 7245 * 7246 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 7247 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 7248 */ 7249 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7250 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 7251 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 7252 7253 /** 7254 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 7255 * @dev: network device 7256 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7257 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 7258 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 7259 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 7260 * @gfp: context flags 7261 */ 7262 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7263 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 7264 7265 /** 7266 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 7267 * @dev: network device 7268 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7269 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 7270 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 7271 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 7272 * @gfp: context flags 7273 * 7274 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 7275 * given interval is exceeded. 7276 */ 7277 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7278 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 7279 7280 /** 7281 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 7282 * @dev: network device 7283 * @gfp: context flags 7284 * 7285 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 7286 */ 7287 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 7288 7289 /** 7290 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 7291 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7292 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7293 * @gfp: context flags 7294 * 7295 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 7296 */ 7297 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7298 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp); 7299 7300 /** 7301 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 7302 * @dev: network device 7303 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 7304 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 7305 * @gfp: context flags 7306 * 7307 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 7308 * frame. 7309 */ 7310 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 7311 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 7312 gfp_t gfp); 7313 7314 /** 7315 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 7316 * @netdev: network device 7317 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7318 * @event: type of event 7319 * @gfp: context flags 7320 * 7321 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 7322 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 7323 * also by full-MAC drivers. 7324 */ 7325 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7326 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7327 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 7328 7329 7330 /** 7331 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 7332 * @dev: network device 7333 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 7334 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 7335 * @gfp: allocation flags 7336 */ 7337 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7338 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 7339 7340 /** 7341 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 7342 * @dev: network device 7343 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 7344 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 7345 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 7346 * @gfp: allocation flags 7347 */ 7348 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 7349 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 7350 7351 /** 7352 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 7353 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7354 * @addr: the transmitter address 7355 * @gfp: context flags 7356 * 7357 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7358 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 7359 * sender. 7360 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7361 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7362 */ 7363 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7364 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7365 7366 /** 7367 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 7368 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7369 * @addr: the transmitter address 7370 * @gfp: context flags 7371 * 7372 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7373 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 7374 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 7375 * station to avoid event flooding. 7376 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7377 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7378 */ 7379 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7380 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7381 7382 /** 7383 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 7384 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 7385 * @addr: the address of the peer 7386 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 7387 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 7388 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 7389 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 7390 * @gfp: allocation flags 7391 */ 7392 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7393 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 7394 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 7395 7396 /** 7397 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 7398 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7399 * @frame: the frame 7400 * @len: length of the frame 7401 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 7402 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7403 * 7404 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7405 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7406 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7407 */ 7408 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 7409 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 7410 7411 /** 7412 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 7413 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7414 * @frame: the frame 7415 * @len: length of the frame 7416 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 7417 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7418 * 7419 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7420 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7421 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7422 */ 7423 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7424 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 7425 int freq, int sig_dbm) 7426 { 7427 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 7428 sig_dbm); 7429 } 7430 7431 /** 7432 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 7433 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7434 * @chandef: the channel definition 7435 * @iftype: interface type 7436 * 7437 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7438 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 7439 */ 7440 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7441 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7442 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7443 7444 /** 7445 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 7446 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7447 * @chandef: the channel definition 7448 * @iftype: interface type 7449 * 7450 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7451 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 7452 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 7453 * more permissive conditions. 7454 * 7455 * Requires the RTNL to be held. 7456 */ 7457 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7458 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7459 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7460 7461 /* 7462 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 7463 * @dev: the device which switched channels 7464 * @chandef: the new channel definition 7465 * 7466 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable 7467 * driver context! 7468 */ 7469 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7470 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 7471 7472 /* 7473 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 7474 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 7475 * @chandef: the future channel definition 7476 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 7477 * 7478 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 7479 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 7480 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 7481 */ 7482 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7483 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7484 u8 count); 7485 7486 /** 7487 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 7488 * 7489 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 7490 * @band: band pointer to fill 7491 * 7492 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7493 */ 7494 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 7495 enum nl80211_band *band); 7496 7497 /** 7498 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 7499 * 7500 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7501 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 7502 * 7503 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7504 */ 7505 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7506 u8 *op_class); 7507 7508 /** 7509 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 7510 * 7511 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7512 * 7513 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 7514 */ 7515 static inline u32 7516 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 7517 { 7518 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 7519 } 7520 7521 /* 7522 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 7523 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 7524 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 7525 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 7526 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 7527 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 7528 * @gfp: allocation flags 7529 * 7530 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 7531 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 7532 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 7533 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 7534 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 7535 */ 7536 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7537 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7538 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7539 7540 /* 7541 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 7542 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 7543 * 7544 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 7545 */ 7546 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 7547 7548 /** 7549 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 7550 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 7551 * 7552 * Call this function only for wdevs that have no netdev assigned, 7553 * e.g. P2P Devices. It removes the device from the list so that 7554 * it can no longer be used. It is necessary to call this function 7555 * even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the interface by 7556 * calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also 7557 * be called when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. 7558 * when the device is unbound from the driver. 7559 * 7560 * Requires the RTNL to be held. 7561 */ 7562 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 7563 7564 /** 7565 * struct cfg80211_ft_event - FT Information Elements 7566 * @ies: FT IEs 7567 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 7568 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 7569 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 7570 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 7571 */ 7572 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 7573 const u8 *ies; 7574 size_t ies_len; 7575 const u8 *target_ap; 7576 const u8 *ric_ies; 7577 size_t ric_ies_len; 7578 }; 7579 7580 /** 7581 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 7582 * @netdev: network device 7583 * @ft_event: IE information 7584 */ 7585 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7586 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 7587 7588 /** 7589 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 7590 * @ies: the input IE buffer 7591 * @len: the input length 7592 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 7593 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 7594 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 7595 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 7596 * 7597 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 7598 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 7599 * 7600 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 7601 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 7602 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 7603 */ 7604 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 7605 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 7606 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 7607 7608 /** 7609 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 7610 * @ies: the IE buffer 7611 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7612 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7613 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7614 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7615 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7616 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 7617 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 7618 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7619 * 7620 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7621 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7622 * split. 7623 * 7624 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7625 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7626 * 7627 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7628 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7629 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7630 * 7631 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7632 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7633 * of the buffer should be used. 7634 */ 7635 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7636 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 7637 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 7638 size_t offset); 7639 7640 /** 7641 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 7642 * @ies: the IE buffer 7643 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7644 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7645 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7646 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7647 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7648 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7649 * 7650 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7651 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7652 * split. 7653 * 7654 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7655 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7656 * 7657 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7658 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7659 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7660 * 7661 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7662 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7663 * of the buffer should be used. 7664 */ 7665 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7666 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 7667 { 7668 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 7669 } 7670 7671 /** 7672 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 7673 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 7674 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 7675 * @gfp: allocation flags 7676 * 7677 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 7678 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 7679 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 7680 * else caused the wakeup. 7681 */ 7682 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7683 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7684 gfp_t gfp); 7685 7686 /** 7687 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 7688 * 7689 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 7690 * @gfp: allocation flags 7691 * 7692 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 7693 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 7694 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 7695 */ 7696 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 7697 7698 /** 7699 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 7700 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7701 * 7702 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 7703 */ 7704 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7705 7706 /** 7707 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 7708 * 7709 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7710 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7711 * 7712 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 7713 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 7714 * the interface combinations. 7715 */ 7716 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7717 struct iface_combination_params *params); 7718 7719 /** 7720 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 7721 * 7722 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7723 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7724 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 7725 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 7726 * 7727 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 7728 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 7729 * purposes. 7730 */ 7731 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7732 struct iface_combination_params *params, 7733 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 7734 void *data), 7735 void *data); 7736 7737 /* 7738 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 7739 * 7740 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7741 * @wdev: wireless device 7742 * @gfp: context flags 7743 * 7744 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 7745 * disconnected. 7746 * 7747 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 7748 */ 7749 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7750 gfp_t gfp); 7751 7752 /** 7753 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 7754 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 7755 * 7756 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 7757 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 7758 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 7759 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 7760 * 7761 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 7762 * the driver while the function is running. 7763 */ 7764 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7765 7766 /** 7767 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 7768 * 7769 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 7770 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 7771 * 7772 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 7773 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 7774 */ 7775 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7776 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 7777 { 7778 u8 *ft_byte; 7779 7780 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 7781 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 7782 } 7783 7784 /** 7785 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 7786 * 7787 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 7788 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 7789 * 7790 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 7791 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 7792 */ 7793 static inline bool 7794 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7795 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 7796 { 7797 u8 ft_byte; 7798 7799 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 7800 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 7801 } 7802 7803 /** 7804 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 7805 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 7806 * 7807 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 7808 */ 7809 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 7810 7811 /** 7812 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 7813 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 7814 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 7815 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 7816 * result. 7817 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 7818 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7819 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 7820 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 7821 * @info_len: the length of the &info 7822 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 7823 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 7824 */ 7825 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 7826 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 7827 u8 inst_id; 7828 u8 peer_inst_id; 7829 const u8 *addr; 7830 u8 info_len; 7831 const u8 *info; 7832 u64 cookie; 7833 }; 7834 7835 /** 7836 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 7837 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 7838 * @match: match notification parameters 7839 * @gfp: allocation flags 7840 * 7841 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 7842 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 7843 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 7844 */ 7845 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7846 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 7847 7848 /** 7849 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7850 * 7851 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 7852 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7853 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7854 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 7855 * @gfp: allocation flags 7856 * 7857 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 7858 */ 7859 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7860 u8 inst_id, 7861 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7862 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 7863 7864 /* ethtool helper */ 7865 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 7866 7867 /** 7868 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 7869 * @netdev: network device 7870 * @params: External authentication parameters 7871 * @gfp: allocation flags 7872 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 7873 */ 7874 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 7875 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 7876 gfp_t gfp); 7877 7878 /** 7879 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 7880 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 7881 * @req: the original measurement request 7882 * @result: the result data 7883 * @gfp: allocation flags 7884 */ 7885 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7886 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 7887 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 7888 gfp_t gfp); 7889 7890 /** 7891 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 7892 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 7893 * @req: the original measurement request 7894 * @gfp: allocation flags 7895 * 7896 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 7897 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 7898 */ 7899 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7900 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 7901 gfp_t gfp); 7902 7903 /** 7904 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 7905 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7906 * @iftype: interface type 7907 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 7908 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 7909 * 7910 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 7911 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 7912 * check_swif is '1'. 7913 */ 7914 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 7915 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 7916 7917 7918 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 7919 7920 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 7921 7922 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 7923 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7924 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7925 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7926 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7927 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7928 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7929 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7930 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7931 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7932 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7933 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7934 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7935 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7936 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7937 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7938 7939 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7940 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7941 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7942 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7943 7944 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7945 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 7946 7947 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7948 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7949 7950 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 7951 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 7952 #else 7953 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7954 ({ \ 7955 if (0) \ 7956 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 7957 0; \ 7958 }) 7959 #endif 7960 7961 /* 7962 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 7963 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 7964 * file/line information and a backtrace. 7965 */ 7966 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7967 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 7968 7969 /** 7970 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 7971 * @netdev: network device 7972 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 7973 * @gfp: allocation flags 7974 */ 7975 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7976 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 7977 gfp_t gfp); 7978 7979 /** 7980 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 7981 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7982 */ 7983 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7984 7985 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 7986